blob: 08cbff3471f74abd6f0d59f0da065554ec28b464 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002656http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002657http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002659http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002660http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002661http-check set-var X - X X
2662http-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002664http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002665http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002666http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002667id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002668ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002669load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002670log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002671log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002672log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002673log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002674max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002675maxconn X X X -
2676mode X X X X
2677monitor fail - X X -
2678monitor-net X X X -
2679monitor-uri X X X -
2680option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2681option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2682option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2683option allbackups (*) X - X X
2684option checkcache (*) X - X X
2685option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2686option contstats (*) X X X -
2687option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2688option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002689-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2690option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002691option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2692option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002693option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002694option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002695option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002696option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002697option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2699option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2700option httpchk X - X X
2701option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002702option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002704option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002705option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002706option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002707option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2708option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2709option logasap (*) X X X -
2710option mysql-check X - X X
2711option nolinger (*) X X X X
2712option originalto X X X X
2713option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002714option pgsql-check X - X X
2715option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002716option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002717option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002718option smtpchk X - X X
2719option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2720option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2721option splice-request (*) X X X X
2722option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002723option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2725option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2726-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002727option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002728option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2729option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2730option tcpka X X X X
2731option tcplog X X X X
2732option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002733external-check command X - X X
2734external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2736rate-limit sessions X X X -
2737redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002738-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002740retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002741server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002742server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002743server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002744source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002745stats admin - X X X
2746stats auth X X X X
2747stats enable X X X X
2748stats hide-version X X X X
2749stats http-request - X X X
2750stats realm X X X X
2751stats refresh X X X X
2752stats scope X X X X
2753stats show-desc X X X X
2754stats show-legends X X X X
2755stats show-node X X X X
2756stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002757-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2758stick match - - X X
2759stick on - - X X
2760stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002761stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002762stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002763tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002764tcp-check connect X - X X
2765tcp-check expect X - X X
2766tcp-check send X - X X
2767tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2768tcp-check set-var X - X X
2769tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002770tcp-request connection - X X -
2771tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002772tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002773tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002774tcp-response content - - X X
2775tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776timeout check X - X X
2777timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002778timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2781timeout http-request X X X X
2782timeout queue X - X X
2783timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002784timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002786timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002787transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002788unique-id-format X X X -
2789unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002790use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002791use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002792use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002793------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2794 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2798---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2801
2802
2803acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2804 Declare or complete an access list.
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 no | yes | yes | yes
2807 Example:
2808 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2809 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2810 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002812 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
2814
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815backlog <conns>
2816 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | no
2819 Arguments :
2820 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2821 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002823
2824 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2825 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2826 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2827 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2828 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2829 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2830 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2831 backlog parameter.
2832
2833 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2834 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2835 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2836
2837 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2838
2839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002841balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 yes | no | yes | yes
2845 Arguments :
2846 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2847 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2848 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2849 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2850
2851 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2852 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2853 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2854 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002855 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002856 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002857 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2858 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2859 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2860 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2861 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2862 it, so that you don't worry.
2863
2864 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2865 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2866 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2867 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2868 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2869 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2870 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2871 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002873 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2874 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2875 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2876 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2877 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2878 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2879 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2880 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2881
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002883 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002884 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2885 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002886 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002887 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2888 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2889 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2890 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2891 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002892 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2893 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2894 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2895 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2896 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2897 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2900 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2901 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2902 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2903 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2904 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2905 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2906 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002907 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002909 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2910 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2911 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002913 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2914 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2915 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2916 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2917 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2918 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2919 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2920 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2921 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2922 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2923 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2924 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002926 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002927 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2928 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2929 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2930 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2931 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2932 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2933 URIs start with a leading "/".
2934
2935 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2936 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2937 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2938 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002940 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2942
2943 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002944 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2945 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2947 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2948 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2949 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002950 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002951 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2952 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953
2954 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2955 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2956 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2957 server will receive the request.
2958
2959 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2960 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2961 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2962 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2963 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002964 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2965 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2966 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002968 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2969 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2970 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2971 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2972 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002974 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002975 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2976 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2977 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2978
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002979 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2980 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2981 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2982
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002983 random
2984 random(<draws>)
2985 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002986 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2987 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2988 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2989 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002990 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2991 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2992 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2993 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2994 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2995 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2996 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2997 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2998 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2999 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3000 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3001 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3002 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3003 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3004 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3005 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3006 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3007 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3008 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3009 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003010
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003011 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003012 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003013 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3014 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3015 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3016 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3017 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3018 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003020 used instead.
3021
3022 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3023 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3024 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3025 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3026
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3028 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3029 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003031 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3044 NTLM relies on.
3045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046 Examples :
3047 balance roundrobin
3048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3051 balance hdr(host)
3052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053
3054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003062
3063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3065 defaults to 16 kB.
3066
3067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3069
3070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3071 Round Robin.
3072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3077
3078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3079
3080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 no | yes | yes | no
3094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3108 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3109 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3110 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3111 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3112 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3113 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003114 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3115 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3116 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003117 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3118 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3119 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3120 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003121 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3122 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3123 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3126 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003127 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3128 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3129 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003130 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3131 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3132 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3133 the range.
3134
3135 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3136 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3137 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3138 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3139 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3140 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3141 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003142 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003143 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003145 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003146 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003147 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3148 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3149 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3150 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3151 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3152 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003154 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3155 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3156 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3157 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3160 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3161 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3162 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3163 in a frontend.
3164
3165 Example :
3166 listen http_proxy
3167 bind :80,:443
3168 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003169 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003171 listen http_https_proxy
3172 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003173 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003174
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003175 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3176 bind ipv6@:80
3177 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3178 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3179
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003180 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003181 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003182
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003183 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3184 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3185 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3186 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3187 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3188
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003189 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003190 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003191
3192
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003193bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 yes | yes | yes | yes
3197 Arguments :
3198 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3199 may be used to override a default value.
3200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003201 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003202 option may be combined with other numbers.
3203
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003204 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003205 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3206 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3207 missing from all processes.
3208
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003209 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003210 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003211 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3212 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3213 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3214 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3215 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003216 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003217
3218 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3219 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3220 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3221 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3222 and 'even' instances.
3223
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003224 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3225 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3226 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3227 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003229 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3230 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3231
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003232 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3233 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3234 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3235
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003236 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3237 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3238
3239 Example :
3240 listen app_ip1
3241 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
3244 listen app_ip2
3245 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003246 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003247
3248 listen management
3249 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003250 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003251
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003252 listen management
3253 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3254 bind-process 1-4
3255
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003256 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003257
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259capture cookie <name> len <length>
3260 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 no | yes | yes | no
3263 Arguments :
3264 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3265 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3266 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3267 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003268 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3271 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3272 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3273 right if it exceeds <length>.
3274
3275 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3276 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3277 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3278 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3279
3280 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3281 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3282 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3283
3284 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3285 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3286 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003287 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3288 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3289 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290
3291 Example:
3292 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3293
3294 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003295 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
3297
3298capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003299 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | no
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003304 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3306 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3307 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3308
3309 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3310 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3311 it exceeds <length>.
3312
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003313 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003314 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3315 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3317 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3318 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3319 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003320 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003321 environments to find where the request came from.
3322
3323 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3324 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3325 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3326 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003328 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3329 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3330 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3331 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3332 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
3334 Example:
3335 capture request header Host len 15
3336 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003337 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003339 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 about logging.
3341
3342
3343capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003344 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 no | yes | yes | no
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003349 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003350 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3351 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3352 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3353
3354 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3355 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3356 it exceeds <length>.
3357
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003358 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3360 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3361 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003362 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3363 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3364 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3365 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003367 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3368 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3369 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3370 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3371 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
3373 Example:
3374 capture response header Content-length len 9
3375 capture response header Location len 15
3376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003377 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378 about logging.
3379
3380
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003381compression algo <algorithm> ...
3382compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003383compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003384 Enable HTTP compression.
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3389 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3390 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3391
3392 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003393 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3394 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3395 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003397 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003398 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399
3400 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3401 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3402 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3403 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3404 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003405 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003406
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003407 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3408 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3409 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3410 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3411 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3412 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3413 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003414 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003415
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003416 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003417 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003418 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3419 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3420 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3421 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3422 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003423
3424 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3425 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3426 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3427 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3428 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003429 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3430 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3431 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3432 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3433 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003434 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3435 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003436
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003437 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003438 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3439 "Accept-Encoding" header
3440 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003441 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003442 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3443 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3444 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3445 "multipart"
3446 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3447 header
3448 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3449 and later
3450 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3451 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003452 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003453
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003454 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003455
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003456 Examples :
3457 compression algo gzip
3458 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003461cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003462 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3463 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003464 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
3469 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3470 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3471 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3472 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3473 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3474 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3477 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3478
3479 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3480 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3481 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3482 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3483 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3484 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003485 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3486 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003487 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003488 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3489 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490
3491 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003492 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003494 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003495 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003496 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003497 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003498 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3499 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3500 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3501 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3502 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3503 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3504 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
3506 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3507 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3508 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3509 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3510 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3511 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3512 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3513 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3514 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003515 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003516 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3517 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3518 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003520 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3521 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3522 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003523 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3524 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3525 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3526 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003527 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3528 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3529 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
3531 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3532 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3533 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3534 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3535 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3536 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3537 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3538 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3539 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3540
3541 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3542 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3543 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3544 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3545 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3546 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3547 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3548 persistence cookie in the cache.
3549 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3550
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003551 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3552 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3553 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3554 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3555 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003557 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3558 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3559 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3560 they logout.
3561
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003562 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3563 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3564 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3565 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3566
3567 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3568 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3569 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3570 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3571 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3572 this attribute.
3573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003576 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3577 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3578 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3579 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3580 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3581 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003583 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3584 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3585 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3586 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3587 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3588 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3589 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3590 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003592 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3593 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3594 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3595 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3596 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3597 the site.
3598
3599 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3600 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3601 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3602 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3603 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3604 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3605 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3606 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3607 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3608 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3609 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3610 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3611 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003613 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3614 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3615
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003616 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3617 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3618 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3619 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3620 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3621 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3622
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003623 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3624 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3625 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3626 repeated.
3627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3629 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3630 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3631 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 Examples :
3634 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3636 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003637 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003639 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003641
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003642declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3643 Declares a capture slot.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments:
3647 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3648
3649 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3650 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3651 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3652 for use in the response.
3653
3654 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003655 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3657
3658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003659default-server [param*]
3660 Change default options for a server in a backend
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | no | yes | yes
3663 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3667 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003670 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3671
3672 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675default_backend <backend>
3676 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | no
3679 Arguments :
3680 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3681
3682 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3683 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3684 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3685 will catch all undetermined requests.
3686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 Example :
3688
3689 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3690 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3691 default_backend dynamic
3692
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003693 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003696description <string>
3697 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 no | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments : string
3701
3702 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3703 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3704 it describes.
3705 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3706
3707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708disabled
3709 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712 Arguments : none
3713
3714 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3715 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3716 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3717 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3718 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3719 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3720 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3721
3722 See also : "enabled"
3723
3724
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725dispatch <address>:<port>
3726 Set a default server address
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003730
3731 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3732 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3733 during start-up.
3734
3735 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3736 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3737 possible with normal servers.
3738
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003739 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003740 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3741 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3742 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3743 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3744
3745 See also : "server"
3746
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003747
3748dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3749 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3753
3754 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003755 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003756 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3757 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003758 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003759 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761enabled
3762 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765 Arguments : none
3766
3767 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3768 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3769
3770 See also : "disabled"
3771
3772
3773errorfile <code> <file>
3774 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3776 yes | yes | yes | yes
3777 Arguments :
3778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003779 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3780 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003783 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003785 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3786 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003787
3788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3795 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3796 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3797 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3798
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003799 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3800 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003801 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003802 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3803 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3804 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003806 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3807 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3808 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003809 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3811
3812 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3813
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003814 Example :
3815 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003816 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003817 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3818 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3819
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003820
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003821errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3822 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3823 section.
3824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | yes | yes | yes
3826 Arguments :
3827 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3828
3829 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3830 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3831 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3832
3833 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3834 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3835 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3836 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3837 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3838 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3839 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3840
3841 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3842 3.8 about http-errors.
3843
3844 Example :
3845 errorfiles generic
3846 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3847
3848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849errorloc <code> <url>
3850errorloc302 <code> <url>
3851 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | yes
3854 Arguments :
3855 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003856 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3857 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003858
3859 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3860 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3861 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3862 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003863 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864
3865 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3866 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3867 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003869 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3872 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3873 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3874 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003875 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3877 request.
3878
3879 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3880
3881
3882errorloc303 <code> <url>
3883 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 yes | yes | yes | yes
3886 Arguments :
3887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003888 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3889 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3892 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3893 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3894 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003896
3897 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3898 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3899 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3900
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003901 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3904 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3905 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3906 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003907 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003908
3909 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3910
3911
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003912email-alert from <emailaddr>
3913 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003914 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | yes
3917
3918 Arguments :
3919
3920 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3921
3922 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3923 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003925 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003926 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3927 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003928
3929
3930email-alert level <level>
3931 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3932 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935
3936 Arguments :
3937
3938 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3939 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3940 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3941
3942 By default level is alert
3943
3944 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3945 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3946 for the proxy.
3947
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003948 Alerts are sent when :
3949
3950 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3951 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3952 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3953 is notice or lower
3954 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3955 and a health check status update occurs
3956
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003957 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3958 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003959 section 3.6 about mailers.
3960
3961
3962email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3963 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966
3967 Arguments :
3968
3969 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3970
3971 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3972 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3973
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003974 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3975 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003976
3977
3978email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3979 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3980 mailers.
3981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3982 yes | yes | yes | yes
3983
3984 Arguments :
3985
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003986 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003987
3988 By default the systems hostname is used.
3989
3990 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3991 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3992 for the proxy.
3993
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003994 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3995 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003996
3997
3998email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003999 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004000 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4002 yes | yes | yes | yes
4003
4004 Arguments :
4005
4006 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4007
4008 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4009 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004012 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4013
4014
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004015force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4016 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004018 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004019
4020 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4021 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4022 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4023 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4024 marked down for maintenance operations.
4025
4026 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4027 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4028 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4029 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4030 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4031 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4032 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4033 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4034 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4035
4036 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4037 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4038 is used.
4039
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004040 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004041 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004042
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004043
4044filter <name> [param*]
4045 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 no | yes | yes | yes
4048 Arguments :
4049 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4050 referenced in section 9.
4051
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004052 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004053 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004054 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4055 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004056
4057 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4058 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4059
4060 Example:
4061 listen
4062 bind *:80
4063
4064 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4065 filter compression
4066 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4067
4068 compression algo gzip
4069 compression offload
4070
4071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4072
4073 See also : section 9.
4074
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004076fullconn <conns>
4077 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | no | yes | yes
4080 Arguments :
4081 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4082 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004084 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004086 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4088 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4089 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4090 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4091 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004092 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4095 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004096 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4097 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4098 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004100 Example :
4101 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4102 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4103 # connections.
4104 backend dynamic
4105 fullconn 10000
4106 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4107 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4108
4109 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4110
4111
4112grace <time>
4113 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 Arguments :
4117 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4118 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4119 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4120
4121 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4122 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4125
4126 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4127 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4128 simplify it.
4129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131hash-balance-factor <factor>
4132 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | no | yes
4135 Arguments :
4136 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4137 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004138 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004139
4140 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4141 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4142 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4143 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4144 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4145 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4146 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4147
4148 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4149 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4150 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4151 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4152 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4153
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004154 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4155 consistent hashing mechanism.
4156
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004157 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4158
4159
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004160hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004161 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | no | yes | yes
4164 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004165 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4166 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004167
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004168 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4169 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4170 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4171 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4172 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4173 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4174 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4175 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4176 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4177 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004178
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004179 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4180 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4181 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4182 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4183 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4184 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4185 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4186 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4187 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4188 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4189 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4190 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4191 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004192 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4193 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004194
4195 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004197 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004198 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4199 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4200 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004201 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4202 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4203 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004204
4205 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4206 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004207 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4208 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4209 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4210 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4211
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004212 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4213 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4214 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4215 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4216 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4217 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4218 parameter.
4219
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004220 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4221 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4222 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4223 used on strings.
4224
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004225 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4226
4227 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4228 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4229 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4230 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4231 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4232 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4233 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4234 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4235 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4236 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4237 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4238 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004239
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004240 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4241 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4242 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004244 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004245
4246
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004247http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4248 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4249 ones).
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 no | yes | yes | yes
4253
4254 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4255 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4256 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4260
4261 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4262 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4263 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4264
4265 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4266 below.
4267
4268 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4269 instance.
4270
4271 Example:
4272 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4273 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4274 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4275
4276http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4277
4278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4279 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4280 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4281 example, or to pass some internal information.
4282 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4283 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4284 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4285
4286http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4289 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4290
4291http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4294
4295http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4297
4298 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4299
4300 Example:
4301 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4302
4303 # applied to:
4304 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4305
4306 # outputs:
4307 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4308
4309 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4310
4311http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4313
4314 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4315
4316 Example:
4317 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4318
4319 # applied to:
4320 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4321
4322 # outputs:
4323 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4324
4325http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4326
4327 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4328 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4329 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4330
4331http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4333
4334 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4335 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4336 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4337 fallback.
4338
4339 Example:
4340 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4341 http-response set-status 431
4342 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4343 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4344
4345http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4346
4347 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4348 inline.
4349
4350 Arguments:
4351 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4352 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4353 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4354 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4355 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4356 (request and response)
4357 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4358 processing
4359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4360 processing
4361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4362 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4363 and '_'.
4364
4365 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4366 followed by some converters.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4370
4371http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4372
4373 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4374 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4375 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4376 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4377 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004378 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004379 processing.
4380
4381 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4382 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4383 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4384 rules evaluation.
4385
4386http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4387
4388 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4389 details about <var-name>.
4390
4391 Example:
4392 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4393
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004394
4395http-check comment <string>
4396 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4397 it fails.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004401 Arguments :
4402 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4403 rule fails.
4404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004405 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4406 user-friendly error reporting.
4407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4409 "http-check expect".
4410
4411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004412http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4413 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
4414 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004415 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | no | yes | yes
4418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004419 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004420 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4421
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004422 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4423 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4424
4425 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4426 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4427 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4428 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4429
4430 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4431
4432 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4433
4434 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4435
4436 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4437
4438 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4439
4440 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4441 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4442 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4443 is used.
4444
4445 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4446
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004447 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4448 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4449 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4450 different ports or with different servers.
4451
4452 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4453 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4454 the port with a "http-check connect".
4455
4456 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4457 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4458 do.
4459
4460 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4461 unset-var or comment rules.
4462
4463 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004464 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4465 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4466 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4467 option httpchk
4468
4469 http-check connect
4470 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
4471 http-check expect rstatus "^[23][0-9]{2}"
4472 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
4473 http-check send GET / HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
4474 http-check expect rstatus "^[23][0-9]{2}"
4475
4476 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4477
4478 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004479
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004480
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004481http-check disable-on-404
4482 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004485 Arguments : none
4486
4487 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4488 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4489 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4490 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4491 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4492 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4493 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4494 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004495 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4496 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4497 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4498
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004499 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004500
4501
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004502http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004503 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4504 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4505 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004506 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004508 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004509
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004510 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004511 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4512
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004513 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4514 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4515 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4516 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4517 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4518 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4519 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4520 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4521 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4522 result is always conclusive.
4523
4524 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4525 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4526 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
4527 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
4528 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
4529 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
4530 By default "L7OK" is used.
4531
4532 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4533 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4534 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
4535 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
4536 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
4537 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
4538
4539 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4540 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
4541 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
4542 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
4543 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
4544 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4545
4546 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4547 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4548 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4549 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4550
4551 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4552 informational message reported in logs if an error
4553 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4554 log-format string.
4555
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004556 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4557 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004558 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004559 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4560 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4561 details on the supported keywords.
4562
4563 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4564 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4565 with the usual backslash ('\').
4566
4567 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4568 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4569 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4570 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4571 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4572
4573 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004574 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004575 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4576 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4577 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4578
4579 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004581 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4582 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4583 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4584 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4585
4586 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004587 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004588 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4589 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4590 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4591 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4592 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004593 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004594 trace).
4595
4596 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004597 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004598 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4599 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4600 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4601 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4602 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004603 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004604
4605 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4606 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4607 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4608 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4609 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4610 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4611 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4612 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4613
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004614 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4615 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4616 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4617 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4618 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004619
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004620 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4621 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4622
4623 Examples :
4624 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004625 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004626
4627 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004628 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004629
4630 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004631 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004632
4633 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004634 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004635
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004636 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004637 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004638
4639
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004640http-check send [meth <method>] [uri <uri>] [vsn <version>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004641 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [body <string>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004642 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4643 health checks.
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 yes | no | yes | yes
4646 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004647 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4648
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004649 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4650 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4651 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4652 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4653 to invent non-standard ones.
4654
4655 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests.
4656 it defaults to " / " which is accessible by default on almost
4657 any server, but may be changed to any other URI. Query
4658 strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004659
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004660 vsn <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
4661 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4662 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4663 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4664 to add it.
4665
4666 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4667 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4668 to the log-format rules.
4669
4670 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4671 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4672 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004673
4674 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4675 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4676 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4677 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4678 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4679 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4680 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4681 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4682
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004683 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4684 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4685 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send".
4686
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004687 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004688
4689
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004690http-check send-state
4691 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | no | yes | yes
4694 Arguments : none
4695
4696 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4697 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4698 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4699 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4700 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4701
4702 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4703 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4704 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4705 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4706 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004707 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4708 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4709 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4710
4711 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4712 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4713 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4714
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004715 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4716 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4717 checked in multiple backends.
4718
4719 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4720 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4721
4722 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4723 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4724 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4725 one fails.
4726
4727 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4728 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4729 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4730
4731 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4732 server's queue.
4733
4734 Example of a header received by the application server :
4735 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4736 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4737
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004738 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4739 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004741
4742http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004743 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | no | yes | yes
4746
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004747 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004748 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4749 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4752 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4753 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4754 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4755 and '-'.
4756
4757 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4758
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004759 Examples :
4760 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004761
4762
4763http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004764 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | no | yes | yes
4767
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004768 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004769 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4770 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4771 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4772 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4773 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4775 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4776 and '-'.
4777
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004778 Examples :
4779 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781
4782http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004783 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4784
4785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 no | yes | yes | yes
4787
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004788 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4789 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4790 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4791 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4792 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4795 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004799 Example:
4800 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4801 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4802 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804 http-request allow if nagios
4805 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4806 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4807 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004809 Example:
4810 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4811 acl add path /addacl
4812 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004814 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004816 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4817 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004819 Example:
4820 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4821 acl setmap path /setmap
4822 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004824 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4827 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004829 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4830 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004832http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004834 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4835 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4836 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4837 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4838 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4839 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4840 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4841 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004843http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004845 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4846 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4847 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4848 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4849 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4850 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4851 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4852 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004854http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4857 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004858
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004860http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004862 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4863 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4864 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4865 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4866 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004868 Example:
4869 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4870 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004871
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004872http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004873
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004874 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004876http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4877 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004879 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4880 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4881 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4882 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4883 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4884 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4885 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4886 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4887 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004889 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4890 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4891 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004892 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4893
4894 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4895 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4896 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4897 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004901 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4902 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4903 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4904 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4905 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4906 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004908http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004910 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004912http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004914 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4915 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4916 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4917 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4918 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4919 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004920
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004921http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4922 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004924 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4925 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4926 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004927 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4928 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4929 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4930 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4931 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004932 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004933
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004934http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4935 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4936 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4937 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4938
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004939http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4940
4941 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4942 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4943 pointed by <resolvers>.
4944 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4945 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4946 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4947 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4948 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4949 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4950 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4951 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4952 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4953 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4954 to 0.0.0.0.
4955
4956 Example:
4957 resolvers mydns
4958 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4959 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4960 timeout retry 1s
4961 hold valid 10s
4962 hold nx 3s
4963 hold other 3s
4964 hold obsolete 0s
4965 accepted_payload_size 8192
4966
4967 frontend fe
4968 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4969 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4970 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4971
4972 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4973 # which mean DNS resolution error
4974 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4975
4976 default_backend be
4977
4978 backend b_503
4979 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4980 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4981 # 503 error page to end users
4982
4983 backend be
4984 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4985 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4986 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4987 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4988 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4989
4990 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4991 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4992
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004993http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4994
4995 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4996 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4997 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4998 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004999 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5000 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005001
5002 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005004http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5007 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5008 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5009 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5010 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005012http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5015 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5016 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5017 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005019http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5020 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005021
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005022 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005023 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5024 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5025 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5026 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5027 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005028
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005029 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5030 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5031 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5032 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5033 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005034
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005035 Example:
5036 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5037
5038 # applied to:
5039 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5040
5041 # outputs:
5042 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5043
5044 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005045
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005046 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5047
5048 # applied to:
5049 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005050
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005051 # outputs:
5052 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005053
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005054http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5055 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5056
5057 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5058 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5059 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5060 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5061
5062 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5063 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5064 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5065
5066 Example:
5067 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5068 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5069
5070 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5071 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5072
5073 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5074 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5075 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5076 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5077
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005078http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5080
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005081 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5082 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5083 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5084 against.
5085
5086 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5087 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5088 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005089
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005090 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5091 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5092 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5093 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5094 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5095 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5096 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5097 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5098 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005099 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5100 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005101
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005102 Example:
5103 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5104 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005105
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005106 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5107 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005109http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005111
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005112 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5113 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5114 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5115 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005116
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005117 Example:
5118 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005119
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005120 # applied to:
5121 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005123 # outputs:
5124 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005125
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005126http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5127 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5128 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005129 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005130 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5131
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005132 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005133 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5134 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5135 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5136 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005137 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005138 are followed to create the response :
5139
5140 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5141 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5142 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5143 ignored.
5144
5145 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5146 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5147 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5148 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5149 ignored.
5150
5151 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5152 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5153 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5154 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5155 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5156
5157 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5158 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5159 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5160 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5161 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5162 if any, is ignored.
5163
5164 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5165 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5166 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5167 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5168 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5169 as a raw content.
5170
5171 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5172 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5173 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5174 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5175 considered as a raw string.
5176
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005177 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5178 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5179 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5180 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5181
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005182 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5183 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5184 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5185
5186 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5187
5188 Example:
5189 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5190 if { path /ping }
5191
5192 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5193 if { path /favicon.ico }
5194
5195 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5196 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5197 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005199http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5200http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005202 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5203 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5204 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005205
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005206http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5207 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005208
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005209 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5210 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5211 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5212 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005214http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005216 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5217 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5218 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5219 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5220 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005222 Arguments:
5223 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5224 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005226 Example:
5227 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5228 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005230 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5231 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005233http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005235 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5236 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5237 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005239 Arguments:
5240 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5241 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005243 Example:
5244 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5245 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005247 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5248 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5249 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005251http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005253 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5254 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5255 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5256 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5257 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005259 Example:
5260 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5261 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5262 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5263 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5264 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5265 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5266 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5267 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5268 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005270http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005272 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5273 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5274 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5275 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5276 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005281 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5282 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5283 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5284 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5285 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5286 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5287 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5288 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5289 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005291http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005293 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5294 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5295 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5296 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5297 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5298 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5299 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005301http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005303 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5304 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5305 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005307http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005309 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5310 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5311 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5312 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5313 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5314 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5315 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5316 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005320 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5321 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5322 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5323 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5324 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5325 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327 Example :
5328 # prepend the host name before the path
5329 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005331http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005333 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5334 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5335 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5336 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5337 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005339http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005341 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5342 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5343 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5344 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5345 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5346 values have higher priority.
5347 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5348 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5349 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5350 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5351 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005353http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005355 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5356 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5357 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5358 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5359 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5360 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5361 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005363 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005364
5365 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005366 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5367 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005369http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5370 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5371 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5372 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005373 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5374 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005375
5376 Arguments :
5377 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5378 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005379
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005380 See also "option forwardfor".
5381
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005382 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005383 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5384 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5385
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005386 # After the masking this will track connections
5387 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5388 http-request track-sc0 src
5389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5391 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5392
5393http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5394
5395 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5396 expression.
5397
5398 Arguments:
5399 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5400 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005401
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005402 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005403 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5404 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5405
5406 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5407 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5408 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5409
5410http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5411
5412 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5413 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5414 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5415 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5416 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5417 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5418 information from the request.
5419
5420 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5421
5422http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5423
5424 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5425 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5426 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5427 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5428 path and the query string.
5429 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5430
5431http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5432
5433 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5434 inline.
5435
5436 Arguments:
5437 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5438 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5439 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5440 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5441 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5442 (request and response)
5443 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5444 processing
5445 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5446 processing
5447 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5448 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5449 and '_'.
5450
5451 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5452 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005453
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005454 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005455 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005457http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5458 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005460 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5461 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5462 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5463 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5464 agent name must be used.
5465
5466 Arguments:
5467 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5468
5469 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5470 configuration.
5471
5472http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5473
5474 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5475 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5476 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5477 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5478 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5479 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5480 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5481 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5482 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5483 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5484 action.
5485 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5486 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5487 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5488 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5489 you fully understand how it works.
5490
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005491http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5492
5493 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5494 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5495 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5496 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5497 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005498 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005499 processing.
5500
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005501 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005502 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5503 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5504 rules evaluation.
5505
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005506http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005508
5509 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5510 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5511 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5512 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5513 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5514 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5515 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5516 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5517 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5518 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5519 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005520 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5521 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5522 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5523 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5524 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5526
5527http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5528http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5529http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5530
5531 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5532 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5533 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5534 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5535 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5536 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5537 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5538 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5539 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5540 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5541 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5542 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5543
5544 Arguments :
5545 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5546 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5547 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5548 select which table entry to update the counters.
5549
5550 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5551 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5552 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5553 that table until the session ends.
5554
5555 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5556 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5557 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5558 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5559 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5560 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5561 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5562 useful information.
5563
5564 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5565 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5566 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5567 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5568 checks that make use of it.
5569
5570http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5571
5572 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005573
5574 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005575 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005576
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005577http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5578
5579 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5580 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5581 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5582 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5583 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5584 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5585
5586 Arguments :
5587 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5588
5589 Example:
5590 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005594 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5595 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5596 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005597
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005599http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005600 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5601
5602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 no | yes | yes | yes
5604
5605 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5606 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5607 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5608 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5609 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5610 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005612 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5613 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005615 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005617 Example:
5618 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005619
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005620 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005622 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5623 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005625 Example:
5626 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005627
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005628 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005629
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005630 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5631 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005633 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5634 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005635
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005636http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005638 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5639 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5640 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5641 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5642 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5643 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5644 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5645 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005647http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5650 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5651 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5652 example, or to pass some internal information.
5653 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5654 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5655 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005659 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5660 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005661
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005662http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005663
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005664 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005666http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005668 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5669 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5670 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5671 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5672 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5673 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5674 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005676 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5677 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5678 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5679 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5680 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005681
5682 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5683 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5684 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5685 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005687http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005689 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5690 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5691 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5692 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5693 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5694 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005696http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005698 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005700http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005702 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5703 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5704 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5705 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5706 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5707 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005708
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005709http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005712 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005713 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5714 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005715 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5716 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5717 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5718 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5719 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005720 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005722http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005723
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005724 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5725 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5726 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5727 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5728 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5729 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005731http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5732 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005733
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005734 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5735 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005737 Example:
5738 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005740 # applied to:
5741 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005743 # outputs:
5744 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005746 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005748http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5749 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005750
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005751 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005752 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005754 Example:
5755 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005757 # applied to:
5758 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005760 # outputs:
5761 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005762
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005763http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5764 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5765 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005766 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5768
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005769 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005770 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5771 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5772 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5773 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005774 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005775 are followed to create the response :
5776
5777 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5778 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5779 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5780 ignored.
5781
5782 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5783 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5784 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5785 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5786 ignored.
5787
5788 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5789 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5790 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5791 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5792 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5793
5794 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5795 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5796 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5797 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5798 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5799 if any, is ignored.
5800
5801 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5802 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5803 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5804 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5805 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5806 as a raw content.
5807
5808 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5809 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5810 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5811 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5812 considered as a raw string.
5813
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005814 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5815 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5816 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5817 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5818
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005819 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5820 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5821 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5822
5823 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5824
5825 Example:
5826 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5827 if { status eq 404 }
5828
5829 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5830 string "This is the end !" \
5831 if { status eq 500 }
5832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005833http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5834http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005836 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5837 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5838 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005839
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005840http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5841 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005842
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005843 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5844 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5845 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5846 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005848http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005850 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5851 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5852 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5853 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5854 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005856 Arguments:
5857 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005859 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5860 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005862http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005864 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5865 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5866 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005868http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5869
5870 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5871 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5872 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5873 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5874 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5875
5876http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5877
5878 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5879 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5880 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5881 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5882 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5883 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5884 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5885 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5886 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5887
5888http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889
5890 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5891 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5892 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5893 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5894 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5895 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5896 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5897
5898http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5899
5900 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5901 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5902 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5903 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5904 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5905 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5906 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5907 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5908
5909http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5911
5912 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5913 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5914 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5915 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005916
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005917 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005918 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5919 http-response set-status 431
5920 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5921 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005923http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005925 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5926 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5927 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5928 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5929 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5930 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5931 based on some information from the request.
5932
5933 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5934
5935http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5936
5937 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5938 inline.
5939
5940 Arguments:
5941 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5942 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5943 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5946 (request and response)
5947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5948 processing
5949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5950 processing
5951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5952 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5953 and '_'.
5954
5955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5956 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005957
5958 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005959 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005961http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005963 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5964 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5965 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5966 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5967 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5968 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5969 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5970 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5971 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5972 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5973 action.
5974 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5975 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5976 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5977 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5978 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005979
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005980http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5981
5982 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5983 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5984 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5985 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5986 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005987 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005988 processing.
5989
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005990 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005991 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5992 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5993 rules evaluation.
5994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005995http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5996http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5997http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005999 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6000 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6001 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6002 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6003 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6004 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6005
6006http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6007
6008 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6009 about <var-name>.
6010
6011 Example:
6012 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6013
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006014
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006015http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6016 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6017
6018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6019 yes | no | yes | yes
6020
6021 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006022 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6023 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6024 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006025
6026 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6027
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006028 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6029 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6030 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6031 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6032 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6033 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6034 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6035 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6036 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6037 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006038
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006039 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6040 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6041 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6042 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6043 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6044 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6045 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6046 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006047
6048 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6049 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6050 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6051 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6052 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6053 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6054 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6055 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006056 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006057 downsides of rare connection failures.
6058
6059 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6060 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6061 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6062 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6063 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6064 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006065 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006066 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6067 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6068 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6069 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6070 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6071
6072 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006073 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6074 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6075 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006076
6077 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006078 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006079
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006080 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6081 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006082
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006083 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006084
6085 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6086 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6087 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6088
6089 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6090
6091
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006092http-send-name-header [<header>]
6093 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006096 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006097 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6098
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006099 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6100 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6101 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6102 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6103 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6104 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6105 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6106 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6107 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6108 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6109 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6110 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6111 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6112 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6113 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6114 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006115
6116 See also : "server"
6117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006118id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006119 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 no | yes | yes | yes
6122 Arguments : none
6123
6124 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6125 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6126 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006127
6128
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006129ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6130 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006132 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006133
6134 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6135 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6136 and running).
6137
6138 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6139 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6140 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006141 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006142 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6143
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006144 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6145 "unless" condition is met.
6146
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006147 Example:
6148 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6149 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6150 ignore-persist if url_static
6151
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006152 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6153
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006154load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6155 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
6158
6159 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6160 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6161 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006162 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006163 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6164 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6165 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6166 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6167
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006168 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006169 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006170 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006171
6172 Arguments:
6173 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6174 named "server-state-file".
6175
6176 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6177 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6178 name is used as a file name.
6179
6180 none don't load any stat for this backend
6181
6182 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006183 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6184 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6185 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006186 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006187 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006188
6189 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6190 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006192 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006194 global
6195 stats socket /tmp/socket
6196 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006198 defaults
6199 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006200
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006201 backend bk
6202 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6203 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006204
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006205
6206 Then one can run :
6207
6208 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6209
6210 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6211
6212 1
6213 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6214 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6215 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6216
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006217 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006218
6219 global
6220 stats socket /tmp/socket
6221 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6222
6223 defaults
6224 load-server-state-from-file local
6225
6226 backend bk
6227 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6228 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6229
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006230
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006231 Then one can run :
6232
6233 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6234
6235 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6236
6237 1
6238 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6239 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6240 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6241
6242 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6243 "show servers state"
6244
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006245
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006246log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006247log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6248 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006249no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006250 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006253
6254 Prefix :
6255 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6256 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6257 prefix does not allow arguments.
6258
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006259 Arguments :
6260 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6261 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6262 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6263 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6264 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6265 parameter.
6266
6267 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6268 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6269
6270 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6271 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6272 standard syslog port).
6273
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006274 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6275 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6276 standard syslog port).
6277
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006278 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6279 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6280 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006281 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006282
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006283 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6284 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6285 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6286 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6287 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6288 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6289 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6290 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6291 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6292 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6293 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6294 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6295 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6296 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6297 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6298 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006299 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6300 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006301
6302 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6303 and "fd@2", see above.
6304
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006305 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6306 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6307 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6308 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6309 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6310 having the logs instantly available.
6311
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006312 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6313 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006314
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006315 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6316 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6317 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6318 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6319 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6320 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6321 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6322 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6323 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6324 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006325 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006326
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006327 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6328 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6329 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6330 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6331 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6332
6333 <sample_size>
6334 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6335 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6336 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6337 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6338 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6339
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006340 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6341 one of the following :
6342
6343 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6344 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6345
6346 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6347 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6348
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006349 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6350 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6351 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6352 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6353 systemd logger consumes.
6354
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006355 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6356 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6357 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6358 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006360 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6361
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006362 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6363 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6364 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6365
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006366 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6367 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6368 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6369 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006370
6371 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6372 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6373 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006374 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6375 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6376 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6377 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6378 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006379
6380 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6381
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006382 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6383 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6384 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006385
6386 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6387 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6388 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6389 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6390
6391 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6392 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006393
6394 Example :
6395 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006396 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6397 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6398 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006399 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6400 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006401 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006403
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006404log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006405 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6407 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006408
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006409 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6410 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6411 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6412 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6413 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006414
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006415 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6416 "option httplog" directives.
6417
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006418log-format-sd <string>
6419 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 yes | yes | yes | no
6422
6423 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6424 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6425 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6426 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6427 which covers the log format string in depth.
6428
6429 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6430 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6431
6432 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6433 log format to "rfc5424".
6434
6435 Example :
6436 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6437
6438
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006439log-tag <string>
6440 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | yes | yes | yes
6443
6444 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6445 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6446 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6447 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6448 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6449 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6450 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6451 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6452 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006453
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006454max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6455 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | no | yes | yes
6458
6459 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6460 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6461 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6462 servers.
6463
6464 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6465 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6466 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6467 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6468 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006469 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006470 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6471 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6472 picking a different server.
6473
6474 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6475 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6476 even if they have to be queued.
6477
6478 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6479 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6480
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006481max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6482 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6483 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6484 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006486maxconn <conns>
6487 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6489 yes | yes | yes | no
6490 Arguments :
6491 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6492 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6493 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6494 closes.
6495
6496 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6497 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6498 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6499 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006500 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6501 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6502 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6503 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006504
6505 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6506 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6507 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6508
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006509 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6510 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006512 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6513
6514
6515mode { tcp|http|health }
6516 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6518 yes | yes | yes | yes
6519 Arguments :
6520 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6521 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6522 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6523 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6524
6525 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6526 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6527 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6528 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6529 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6530
6531 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006532 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6533 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6534 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6535 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6536 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6537 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6538 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006539
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006540 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6541 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6542 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006543
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006544 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006545 defaults http_instances
6546 mode http
6547
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006548 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006550
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006551monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006552 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6554 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006555 Arguments :
6556 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6557 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006558 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006559 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6560 backend and its backup.
6561
6562 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6563 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6564 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6565 servers in a list of backends.
6566
6567 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6568 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6569 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6570 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6571 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6572 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6573 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006574 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6575 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006576
6577 Example:
6578 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006579 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006580 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6581 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6582 monitor-uri /site_alive
6583 monitor fail if site_dead
6584
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006585 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006586
6587
6588monitor-net <source>
6589 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6591 yes | yes | yes | no
6592 Arguments :
6593 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6594 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6595 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6596 followed by a mask.
6597
6598 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6599 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006600 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006601 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6602
6603 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6604 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6605 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6606 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006607 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6608 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6609 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006610
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006611 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6612 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6613 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6614 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6615 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6616 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006617
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006618 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6619 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006621 Example :
6622 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6623 frontend www
6624 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6625
6626 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6627
6628
6629monitor-uri <uri>
6630 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6632 yes | yes | yes | no
6633 Arguments :
6634 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6635 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6636
6637 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6638 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6639 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6640 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6641 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6642 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6643 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6644 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6645
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006646 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006647 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6648 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6649 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6650 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6651 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6652 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006653
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006654 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6655 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6656 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6657 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6658
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006659 Example :
6660 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6661 frontend www
6662 mode http
6663 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6664
6665 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006667
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006668option abortonclose
6669no option abortonclose
6670 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | no | yes | yes
6673 Arguments : none
6674
6675 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6676 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6677 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6678 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006679 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006680 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6681 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6682 encountered while delivering the response.
6683
6684 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6685 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6686 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6687 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6688 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6689 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006690 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006691 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006692 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006693 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6694 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6695 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006697 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6698 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006699 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6700 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6701 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6702 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6703 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6704 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006705 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006706
6707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6709
6710 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6711
6712
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006713option accept-invalid-http-request
6714no option accept-invalid-http-request
6715 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 yes | yes | yes | no
6718 Arguments : none
6719
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006720 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006721 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006722 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006723 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6724 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6725 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6726 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6727 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006728 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6729 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6730 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6731 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006732 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006733 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006734 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6735 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6736 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006737
6738 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6739 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6740 been confirmed.
6741
6742 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6743 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006744 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6745 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006746 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6747
6748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6750
6751 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6752 stats socket.
6753
6754
6755option accept-invalid-http-response
6756no option accept-invalid-http-response
6757 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6759 yes | no | yes | yes
6760 Arguments : none
6761
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006762 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006763 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006764 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006765 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6766 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6767 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6768 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6769 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006770 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6771 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6772 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006773
6774 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6775 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6776 been confirmed.
6777
6778 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6779 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6780 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6781 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6782
6783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6785
6786 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6787 stats socket.
6788
6789
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006790option allbackups
6791no option allbackups
6792 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6794 yes | no | yes | yes
6795 Arguments : none
6796
6797 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6798 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6799 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6800 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6801 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6802 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6803 order between the backup servers anymore.
6804
6805 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6806 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6807
6808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6810
6811
6812option checkcache
6813no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006814 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 yes | no | yes | yes
6817 Arguments : none
6818
6819 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6820 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006821 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006822 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6823 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006824 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006825
6826 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006827 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006828 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006829 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6830 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006831 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006832 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006833 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6834 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006835 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006836 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6837 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006838 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006839 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6840 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6841 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6842 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6843 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6844 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6845 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6846 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6847 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6848
6849 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006850 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6851 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6852 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6853 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006854
6855 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6856 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006857 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006858 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006859
6860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6862
6863
6864option clitcpka
6865no option clitcpka
6866 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6868 yes | yes | yes | no
6869 Arguments : none
6870
6871 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6872 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006873 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006874 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6875
6876 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6877 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6878 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6879 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6880
6881 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6882 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6883 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6884 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6885 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6886
6887 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6888
6889 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6890 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6891 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6892
6893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6895
6896 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6897
6898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006899option contstats
6900 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6902 yes | yes | yes | no
6903 Arguments : none
6904
6905 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6906 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6907 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6908 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006909 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6910 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6911 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6912 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6913 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006914
6915
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006916option dontlog-normal
6917no option dontlog-normal
6918 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | no
6921 Arguments : none
6922
6923 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6924 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6925 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6926 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6927 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6928 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6929 logged.
6930
6931 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6932 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6933 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006936 logging.
6937
6938
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006939option dontlognull
6940no option dontlognull
6941 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 yes | yes | yes | no
6944 Arguments : none
6945
6946 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6947 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6948 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6949 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6950 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6951 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006952 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6953 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6954 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006955
6956 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006957 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006958 would not be logged.
6959
6960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6962
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006963 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6964 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006965
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006966
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006967option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006968 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | yes | yes | yes
6971 Arguments :
6972 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6973 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006974 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006975 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006976
6977 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6978 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6979 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6980 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6981 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6982 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6983 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006984 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6985 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6986 possible that the client has already brought one.
6987
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006988 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006989 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006990 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006991 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006992 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006993 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006994
6995 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6996 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6997 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6998 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6999 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7000 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7001 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7002
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007003 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7004 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7005 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7006 are under the control of the end-user.
7007
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007008 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007009 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7010 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007011 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7012 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7013 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007014
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007015 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007016 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7017 frontend www
7018 mode http
7019 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7020
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007021 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7022 backend www
7023 mode http
7024 option forwardfor header X-Client
7025
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007026 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007027 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007028
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007029
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007030option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7031no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7032 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7034 yes | yes | yes | no
7035 Arguments : none
7036
7037 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7038 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7039 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7040 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7041 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7042 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7043 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7044
7045 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7046 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7047 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7048 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7049 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7050 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7051 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7052 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7053 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7054 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7055
7056 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7057
7058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7060
7061 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7062 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7063
7064
7065option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7066no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7067 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7069 yes | no | yes | yes
7070 Arguments : none
7071
7072 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7073 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7074 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7075 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7076 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7077 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7078 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7079
7080 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7081 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7082 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7083 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7084 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7085 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7086 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7087 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7088 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7089 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7090
7091 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7092
7093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7095
7096 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7097 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7098
7099
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007100option http-buffer-request
7101no option http-buffer-request
7102 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 yes | yes | yes | yes
7105 Arguments : none
7106
7107 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7108 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7109 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7110 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7111 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7112 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007113 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7114 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7115 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7116 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007117
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007118 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007119
7120
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007121option http-ignore-probes
7122no option http-ignore-probes
7123 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7125 yes | yes | yes | no
7126 Arguments : none
7127
7128 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7129 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7130 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7131 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7132 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7133 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7134 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7135 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7136 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007137 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7138 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007139 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7140
7141 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7142 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7143 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7144 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7145 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7146 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7147 are often the only way to detect them.
7148
7149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7151
7152 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7153
7154
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007155option http-keep-alive
7156no option http-keep-alive
7157 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7159 yes | yes | yes | yes
7160 Arguments : none
7161
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007162 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7163 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007164 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7165 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007166 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7167 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7168 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007169
7170 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7171 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007172 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7173 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7174 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7175 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7176 situations where this option may be useful :
7177
7178 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007180
7181 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7182 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7183
7184 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7185 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7186 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7187 request.
7188
7189 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7190 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007191 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7192 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7193 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007194
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007195 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7196 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7197 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7198 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7199 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7200 not set.
7201
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007202 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7203 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7204 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007205
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007206 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007207 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007208 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007209
7210
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007211option http-no-delay
7212no option http-no-delay
7213 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7215 yes | yes | yes | yes
7216 Arguments : none
7217
7218 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7219 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7220 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7221 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7222 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7223 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7224 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7225 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7226 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7227 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7228 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7229 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7230 affected.
7231
7232 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7233 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7234 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7235 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7236 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7237 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7238 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7239 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7240 latency environments.
7241
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007242 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7243
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007244
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007245option http-pretend-keepalive
7246no option http-pretend-keepalive
7247 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007250 Arguments : none
7251
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007252 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007253 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7254 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7255 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7256 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7257 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7258 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7259 consider the response complete.
7260
7261 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7262 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7263 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7264 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007265 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007266 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7267
7268 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7269 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7270 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7271 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7272 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7273 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7274 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7275
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007276 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7277 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7278 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7279 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7280 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7281 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007282
7283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7285
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007286 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007287 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007288
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007289
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007290option http-server-close
7291no option http-server-close
7292 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | yes | yes | yes
7295 Arguments : none
7296
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007297 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7298 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7299 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7300 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007301 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7302 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7303 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7304 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7305 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7306 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7307 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7308 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7309 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7310 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7311 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007312
7313 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7314 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7315 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7316 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007317 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7318 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007319
7320 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7321 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007322 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7323 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7324 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007325
7326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7328
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007329 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7330 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007331
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007332option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007333no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007334 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | yes | yes | no
7337 Arguments : none
7338
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007339 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007340 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7341 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7342 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7343 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7344 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7345 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7346
7347 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7348 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007349 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7350 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7351 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007352
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007353 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7354 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7355 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7356 front of an existing proxy.
7357
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007358 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7359
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007360 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007361
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007362option httpchk
7363option httpchk <uri>
7364option httpchk <method> <uri>
7365option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007366 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7368 yes | no | yes | yes
7369 Arguments :
7370 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7371 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7372 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7373 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7374 ones.
7375
7376 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7377 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7378 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7379
7380 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7381 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7382 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007383 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007384
7385 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7386 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7387 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7388 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7389 the lack of any response.
7390
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007391 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7392 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7393 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7394 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7395
7396 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7397 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7398 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007400 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7401 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007402 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7403 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7404 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007405
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007406 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7407 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7408 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7409 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007411 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007412 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7413 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7414 backend https_relay
7415 mode tcp
7416 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7417 http-check send hdr Host www
7418 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007419
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007420 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7421 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7422 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007423
7424
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007425option httpclose
7426no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007427 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | yes | yes | yes
7430 Arguments : none
7431
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007432 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7433 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7434 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7435 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007436 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007437
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007438 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7439 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007440 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007441 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7442 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007443
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007444 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7445 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7446 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007447
7448 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7449 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007450 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7451 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7452 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007453
7454 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7455 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007457 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007458
7459
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007460option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007461 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007463 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007464 Arguments :
7465 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7466 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7467 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007468 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007469 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007470
7471 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7472 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7473 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7474 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7475 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7476 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7477 ports.
7478
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007479 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7480 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007481
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007482 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007484 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007485
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007486
7487option http_proxy
7488no option http_proxy
7489 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7491 yes | yes | yes | yes
7492 Arguments : none
7493
7494 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7495 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7496 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7497 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7498 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7499
7500 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7501 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007502 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7503 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007504
7505 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7506 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7507
7508 Example :
7509 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7510 backend direct_forward
7511 option httpclose
7512 option http_proxy
7513
7514 See also : "option httpclose"
7515
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007516
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007517option independent-streams
7518no option independent-streams
7519 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 yes | yes | yes | yes
7522 Arguments : none
7523
7524 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7525 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7526 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7527 receive data or not.
7528
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007530 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7531 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7532 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7533 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7534 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7535 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7536 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7537 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7538 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7539 socket buffers.
7540
7541 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7542 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7543 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7544 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7545 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7546
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007547 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007548
7549
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007550option ldap-check
7551 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 yes | no | yes | yes
7554 Arguments : none
7555
7556 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7557 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7558 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7559 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7560
7561 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7562 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7563
7564 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7565 configure it.
7566
7567 Example :
7568 option ldap-check
7569
7570 See also : "option httpchk"
7571
7572
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007573option external-check
7574 Use external processes for server health checks
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 yes | no | yes | yes
7577
7578 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7579 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7580 command".
7581
7582 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7583
7584 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7585
7586
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007587option log-health-checks
7588no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007589 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7591 yes | no | yes | yes
7592 Arguments : none
7593
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007594 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7595 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7596 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007597
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007598 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7599 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7600 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7601 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7602 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007604 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007605 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007606
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007607 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7608 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7609 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007610
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007611
7612option log-separate-errors
7613no option log-separate-errors
7614 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7616 yes | yes | yes | no
7617 Arguments : none
7618
7619 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7620 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7621 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7622 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7623 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7624 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7625 provides very important information.
7626
7627 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7628 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7629 error logs.
7630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007631 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007632 logging.
7633
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007634
7635option logasap
7636no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007637 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 yes | yes | yes | no
7640 Arguments : none
7641
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007642 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7643 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7644 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7645 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7646
7647 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7648 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7649 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7650 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7651 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7652 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7653 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7654 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7655 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7656 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7657 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007658
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007659 Examples :
7660 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7661 mode http
7662 option httplog
7663 option logasap
7664 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7665
7666 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7667 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7668 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7669 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007671 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007672 logging.
7673
7674
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007675option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007676 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7678 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007679 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007680 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7681 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007682 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007683
7684 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7685 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007686 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007687 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7688 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7689 in the MySQL table, like this :
7690
7691 USE mysql;
7692 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7693 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7694
7695 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007696 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007697 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7698 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7699 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7700 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7701 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7702 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7703 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7704
7705 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7706 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007707
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007708 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007709
7710 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7711 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7712 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7713 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007714 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7715 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007716
7717 See also: "option httpchk"
7718
7719
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007720option nolinger
7721no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007722 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7724 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007725 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007726
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007727 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007728 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7729 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7730 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7731 connections.
7732
7733 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7734 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7735 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7736 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7737 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7738 this too.
7739
7740 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7741 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7742 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7743
7744 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7745 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7746 for servers.
7747
7748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7750
7751
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007752option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7753 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 yes | yes | yes | yes
7756 Arguments :
7757 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7758 matching <network>
7759 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7760 header name.
7761
7762 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7763 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7764 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7765 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7766 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7767 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7768 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7769 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7770 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7771 possible that the client has already brought one.
7772
7773 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7774 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7775 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7776 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7777 header and requires different one.
7778
7779 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7780 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7781 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7782 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7783 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7784 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7785 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7786
7787 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7788 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7789 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7790 both are defined.
7791
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007792 Examples :
7793 # Original Destination address
7794 frontend www
7795 mode http
7796 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7797
7798 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7799 backend www
7800 mode http
7801 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7802
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007803 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007804
7805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007806option persist
7807no option persist
7808 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7810 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007812
7813 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7814 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7815 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7816 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7817 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7818 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7819 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7820 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7821 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7822 redirected to another valid server.
7823
7824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7826
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007827 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007828
7829
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007830option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7831 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 yes | no | yes | yes
7834 Arguments :
7835 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7836 PostgreSQL server.
7837
7838 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7839 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7840 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7841 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7842
7843 See also: "option httpchk"
7844
7845
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007846option prefer-last-server
7847no option prefer-last-server
7848 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 yes | no | yes | yes
7851 Arguments : none
7852
7853 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7854 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7855 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7856 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7857 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7858 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7859 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7860 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7861 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007862 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7863 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007864 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7865 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7866 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007867 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7868 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7869 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007870
7871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7873
7874 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7875
7876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007877option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007878option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007879no option redispatch
7880 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007883 Arguments :
7884 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7885 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7886 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007887 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007888 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007889 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007890 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7891 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7892 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007894
7895 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7896 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7897 be able to access the service anymore.
7898
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007899 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7900 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007901
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007902 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7903 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7904 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7905 following order:
7906
7907 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7908
7909 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7910 list, or
7911
7912 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7913
7914 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7915 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7916
7917 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7918 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7919 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7920 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7921
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007922 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007923 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7924 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7928
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007929 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007930
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007931
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007932option redis-check
7933 Use redis health checks for server testing
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | no | yes | yes
7936 Arguments : none
7937
7938 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7939 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7940 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7941 find the "+PONG" response message.
7942
7943 Example :
7944 option redis-check
7945
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007946 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007947
7948
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007949option smtpchk
7950option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7951 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007954 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007955 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007956 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007957 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7958
7959 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7960 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7961 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7962
7963 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7964 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7965 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7966 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7967 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7968 dead server.
7969
7970 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7971 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007972 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007973 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7974
7975 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7976 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7977 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7978 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007979 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007980
7981 Example :
7982 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7983
7984 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007987option socket-stats
7988no option socket-stats
7989
7990 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7992 yes | yes | yes | no
7993
7994 Arguments : none
7995
7996
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007997option splice-auto
7998no option splice-auto
7999 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments : none
8003
8004 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8005 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008006 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008007 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008008 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008009 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8010 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8011 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8012 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8013
8014 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8015 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8016 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8017 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8018 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8019 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8020 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8021 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8022 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8023 keyword.
8024
8025 Example :
8026 option splice-auto
8027
8028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8030
8031 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8032 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8033
8034
8035option splice-request
8036no option splice-request
8037 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 yes | yes | yes | yes
8040 Arguments : none
8041
8042 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008043 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008044 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8045 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8046 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8047 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8048
8049 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8050
8051 Example :
8052 option splice-request
8053
8054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8056
8057 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8058 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8059
8060
8061option splice-response
8062no option splice-response
8063 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | yes | yes | yes
8066 Arguments : none
8067
8068 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008069 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008070 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8071 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8072 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8073 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8074
8075 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8076
8077 Example :
8078 option splice-response
8079
8080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8082
8083 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8084 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8085
8086
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008087option spop-check
8088 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 no | no | no | yes
8091 Arguments : none
8092
8093 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8094 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8095 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8096 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8097
8098 Example :
8099 option spop-check
8100
8101 See also : "option httpchk"
8102
8103
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008104option srvtcpka
8105no option srvtcpka
8106 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8108 yes | no | yes | yes
8109 Arguments : none
8110
8111 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8112 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008114 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8115
8116 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8117 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8118 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8119 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8120
8121 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8122 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8123 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8124 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8125 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8126
8127 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8128
8129 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8130 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8131 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8132
8133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8135
8136 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8137
8138
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008139option ssl-hello-chk
8140 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | no | yes | yes
8143 Arguments : none
8144
8145 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8146 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8147 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8148 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8149 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8150 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8151 hello message.
8152
8153 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8154 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8155 messages, which is appreciable.
8156
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008157 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8158 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8159 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008160
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008161 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8162
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008163
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008164option tcp-check
8165 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | no | yes | yes
8168
8169 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8170 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8171
8172 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8173 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8174 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008176 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008177 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8178 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8179 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8180 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8181 only.
8182
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008183 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008184 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8185 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8186 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8187 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8188
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008189 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8191 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008192 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008193 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8194 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8195 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8196 the respective protocols.
8197 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008198 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008199
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008200 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008201
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008202 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8203 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8204 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8205 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008206
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008207 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8208 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8209 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008210
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008211
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008212 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008213 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008214 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008215 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008216
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008217 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008218 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008219 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008220
8221 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8222 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008224 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008225 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008226 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008227 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008228 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008229 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8230 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008231 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008232 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8233 tcp-check expect string +OK
8234
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008235 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008236 (send many headers before analyzing)
8237 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008238 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008239 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8240 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8241 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8242 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008243 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008244
8245
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008246 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008247
8248
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008249option tcp-smart-accept
8250no option tcp-smart-accept
8251 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | yes | yes | no
8254 Arguments : none
8255
8256 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8257 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8258 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8259 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8260 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8261 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8262
8263 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8264 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8265 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8266 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8267
8268 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8269 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8270 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008272
8273 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8274 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8275 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8276
8277 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8278 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8279 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8280
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008281 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8282
8283
8284option tcp-smart-connect
8285no option tcp-smart-connect
8286 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8288 yes | no | yes | yes
8289 Arguments : none
8290
8291 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8292 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8293 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8294 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8295 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8296
8297 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8298 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8299 complex.
8300
8301 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8302 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8303 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8304
8305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8307
8308 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8309
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008311option tcpka
8312 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8314 yes | yes | yes | yes
8315 Arguments : none
8316
8317 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8318 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008319 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008320 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8321
8322 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8323 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8324 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8325 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8326
8327 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8328 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8329 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8330 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8331 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8332
8333 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8334
8335 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8336 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8337 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8338 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8339 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8340 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8341 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8342 backends.
8343
8344 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8345
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008346
8347option tcplog
8348 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008350 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008351 Arguments : none
8352
8353 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8354 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8355 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8356 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8357 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8358 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8359 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8360 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8361
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008362 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008364 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008365
8366
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008367option transparent
8368no option transparent
8369 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008371 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008372 Arguments : none
8373
8374 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8375 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8376 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8377 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8378 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8379 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8380 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8381 appropriate server.
8382
8383 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8384 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8385
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008386 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008387 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008388
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008389
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008390external-check command <command>
8391 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8393 yes | no | yes | yes
8394
8395 Arguments :
8396 <command> is the external command to run
8397
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008398 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8399
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008400 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008401
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008402 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8403 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8404 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8405 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8406 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8407 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008408
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008409 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8410
8411 Environment variables :
8412 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8413 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8414
8415 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8416
8417 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8418
8419 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8420 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8421 for a UNIX socket).
8422
8423 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8424
8425 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8426
8427 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8428
8429 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8430
8431 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8432
8433 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8434 socket).
8435
8436 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8437 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8438
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008439 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8440
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008441 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8442 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8443 failed.
8444
8445 Example :
8446 external-check command /bin/true
8447
8448 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8449
8450
8451external-check path <path>
8452 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8454 yes | no | yes | yes
8455
8456 Arguments :
8457 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8458
8459 The default path is "".
8460
8461 Example :
8462 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8463
8464 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8465 "external-check command"
8466
8467
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008468persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008469persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008470 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 yes | no | yes | yes
8473 Arguments :
8474 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008475 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8476 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008477
8478 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8479 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008480 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008481 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8482 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8483 forwarded to this server.
8484
8485 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8486 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8487 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008488 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008489 a single "listen" section.
8490
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008491 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8492 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8493 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8494
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008495 Example :
8496 listen tse-farm
8497 bind :3389
8498 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8499 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8500 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8501 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8502 persist rdp-cookie
8503 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008504 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008505 balance rdp-cookie
8506 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8507 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8508
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008509 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8510 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008511
8512
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008513rate-limit sessions <rate>
8514 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8516 yes | yes | yes | no
8517 Arguments :
8518 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8519 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8520
8521 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8522 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8523 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8524 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8525 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8526 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8527
8528 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8529 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8530 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8531 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8532
8533 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8534 listen smtp
8535 mode tcp
8536 bind :25
8537 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008538 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008539
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008540 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8541 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8542 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008543
8544 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8545
8546
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008547redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8548redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8549redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008550 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 no | yes | yes | yes
8553
8554 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008555 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008556
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008558 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008559 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8560 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8561 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008562
8563 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8564 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8565 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8566 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8567 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008568 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8569 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8570 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8571 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008572
8573 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8574 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8575 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8576 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8577 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8578 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008579 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008580 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008581 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8582 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8583 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008584
8585 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008586 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8587 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8588 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008589 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008590 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8591 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8592 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8593 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008594
8595 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008596 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008597
8598 - "drop-query"
8599 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8600 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8601 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8602 with a location-type redirect.
8603
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008604 - "append-slash"
8605 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8606 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8607 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8608 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8609
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008610 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8611 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8612 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8613 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8614 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8615 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8616 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8617
8618 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8619 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8620 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8621 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8622 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8623 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8624 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008625
8626 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8627 acl clear dst_port 80
8628 acl secure dst_port 8080
8629 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008630 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008631 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008632 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8633
8634 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008635 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8636 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8637 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008638 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008639
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008640 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8641 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8642 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8643
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008644 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008645 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008646
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008647 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008648 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8649 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8650 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008652 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008654
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008655retries <value>
8656 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 yes | no | yes | yes
8659 Arguments :
8660 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8661 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8662 default value is 3.
8663
8664 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8665 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8666 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8667
8668 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008669 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8670 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008671
8672 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8673 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8674
8675 See also : "option redispatch"
8676
8677
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008678retry-on [list of keywords]
8679 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8681 yes | no | yes | yes
8682 Arguments :
8683 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8684 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8685 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8686 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8687
8688 none never retry
8689
8690 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8691 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8692
8693 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8694 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8695 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8696 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8697 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8698 processing the request.
8699
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008700 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8701 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8702 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8703 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8704 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8705 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8706 overflow attack for example).
8707
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008708 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8709 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8710 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8711 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8712 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8713 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8714 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8715 amplify denial of service attacks.
8716
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008717 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8718 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8719 considered to be safe to retry.
8720
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008721 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8722 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8723 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8724 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8725
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008726 all-retryable-errors
8727 retry request for any error that are considered
8728 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8729 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8730 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8731
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008732 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8733 not cumulative.
8734
8735 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8736 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8737 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8738 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8739
8740 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8741 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8742 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8743 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8744 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8745 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8746 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8747 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8748 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8749 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8750 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8751 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8752
8753 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8754 should not use this directive.
8755
8756 The default is "conn-failure".
8757
8758 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8759
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008760server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008761 Declare a server in a backend
8762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8763 no | no | yes | yes
8764 Arguments :
8765 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008766 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008767 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008768
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008769 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8770 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8771 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8772 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008773 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8774 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8775 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8776 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8777 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008778 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8779 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8780 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8781 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8782 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8783 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8784 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008785 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008786 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8787 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8788 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8789 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8790 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8791 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008792 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8793 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008794 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8795 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008797 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008798 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8799 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8800 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8801 adding this value to the client's port.
8802
8803 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8804 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008805 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008806
8807 Examples :
8808 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8809 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008810 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008811 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8812 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8813 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008814
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008815 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8816 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8817 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8818 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8819 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8820
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008821 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8822 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008823
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008824server-state-file-name [<file>]
8825 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8826 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8827 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8828 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8829 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8830 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8831
8832 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8833 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8834
8835 global
8836 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8837
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008838 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008839 load-server-state-from-file
8840
8841 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8842 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008843
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008844server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8845 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8846 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 no | no | yes | yes
8849
8850 Arguments:
8851 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8852
8853 <num | range>
8854 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8855 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8856 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8857 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8858
8859 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8860
8861 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8862
8863 <params*>
8864 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8865 keyword.
8866
8867 Examples:
8868 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8869 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8870 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8871
8872 # or
8873 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8874
8875 # would be equivalent to:
8876 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8877 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8878 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8879
8880
8881
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008882source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008883source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008884source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008885 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8887 yes | no | yes | yes
8888 Arguments :
8889 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8890 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008892 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008893 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8894 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8895 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8896 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8897 supported prefixes are :
8898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008902 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8903 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008904
8905 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8906 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008907 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8908 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8909 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008910
8911 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8912 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8913 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8914 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8915 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8916 <addr>.
8917
8918 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8919 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8920 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8921 port.
8922
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008923 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8924 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8925 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8926 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008927 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008928 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8929 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8930 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8931 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8932 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8933 HTTP header.
8934
8935 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8936 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008937 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008938 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8939 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8940 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8941 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8942 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8943 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8944 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8945
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008946 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8947 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8948 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8949 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8950 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8951 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8952
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008953 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8954 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8955 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8956 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8957
8958 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8959 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8960 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8961 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8962 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8963 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8964
8965 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8966 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8967 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8968 there are two methods :
8969
8970 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8971 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8972 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8973 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8974 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8975 of the client ranges may be used.
8976
8977 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8978 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8979 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8980 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8981 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8982 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8983 same session.
8984
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008985 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8986 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8987 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008988 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008989
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008990 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8991
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008992 Examples :
8993 backend private
8994 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8995 source 192.168.1.200
8996
8997 backend transparent_ssl1
8998 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8999 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9000
9001 backend transparent_ssl2
9002 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9003 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9004 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9005
9006 backend transparent_ssl3
9007 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9008 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9009 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9010
9011 backend transparent_smtp
9012 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9013 # with Tproxy version 4.
9014 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9015
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009016 backend transparent_http
9017 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9018 # proxy.
9019 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009021 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009022 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9023
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009024
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009025stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9026 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009028 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009029
9030 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9031 matched.
9032
9033 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9034 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9035
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009036 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9037 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009038 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009039
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009040 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9041 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9042 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9043 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009044
9045 Example :
9046 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9047 backend stats_localhost
9048 stats enable
9049 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9050
9051 Example :
9052 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9053 backend stats_auth
9054 stats enable
9055 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9056 stats admin if TRUE
9057
9058 Example :
9059 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9060 userlist stats-auth
9061 group admin users admin
9062 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9063 group readonly users haproxy
9064 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9065
9066 backend stats_auth
9067 stats enable
9068 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9069 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9070 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9071 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9072
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009073 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9074 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9075 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009076
9077
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009078stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9079 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009081 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009082 Arguments :
9083 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9084
9085 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9086
9087 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9088 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9089 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9090 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9091 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9092 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9093
9094 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9095 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9096 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009097 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009098
9099 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9100 report using "stats scope".
9101
9102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9104 unobvious parameters.
9105
9106 Example :
9107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9108 backend public_www
9109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9110 stats enable
9111 stats hide-version
9112 stats scope .
9113 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009114 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9117
9118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9119 backend private_monitoring
9120 stats enable
9121 stats uri /admin?stats
9122 stats refresh 5s
9123
9124 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9125
9126
9127stats enable
9128 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009130 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009131 Arguments : none
9132
9133 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9134 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9135 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9136 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9137 - stats auth : no authentication
9138 - stats scope : no restriction
9139
9140 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9141 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9142 unobvious parameters.
9143
9144 Example :
9145 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9146 backend public_www
9147 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9148 stats enable
9149 stats hide-version
9150 stats scope .
9151 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009152 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009153 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9154 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9155
9156 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9157 backend private_monitoring
9158 stats enable
9159 stats uri /admin?stats
9160 stats refresh 5s
9161
9162 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9163
9164
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009165stats hide-version
9166 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009168 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009169 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009170
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009171 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9172 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9173 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9174 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9175 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9176 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009178 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9179 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9180 unobvious parameters.
9181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009182 Example :
9183 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9184 backend public_www
9185 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009186 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009187 stats hide-version
9188 stats scope .
9189 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009190 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009191 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9192 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009193
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009194 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9195 backend private_monitoring
9196 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009197 stats uri /admin?stats
9198 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009199
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009200 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009201
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009202
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009203stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9205 Access control for statistics
9206
9207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9208 no | no | yes | yes
9209
9210 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9211 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9212 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9213 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9214 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9215 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9216
9217 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9218 instance.
9219
9220 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9221 about ACL usage.
9222
9223
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009224stats realm <realm>
9225 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009227 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009228 Arguments :
9229 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9230 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9231 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9232
9233 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9234 using a backslash ('\').
9235
9236 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9237 only related to authentication.
9238
9239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9241 unobvious parameters.
9242
9243 Example :
9244 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9245 backend public_www
9246 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9247 stats enable
9248 stats hide-version
9249 stats scope .
9250 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009251 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009252 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9253 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9254
9255 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9256 backend private_monitoring
9257 stats enable
9258 stats uri /admin?stats
9259 stats refresh 5s
9260
9261 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9262
9263
9264stats refresh <delay>
9265 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009268 Arguments :
9269 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9270 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9271 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9272 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9273 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9274 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9275
9276 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9277 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9278 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9279 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9280
9281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9283 unobvious parameters.
9284
9285 Example :
9286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9287 backend public_www
9288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9289 stats enable
9290 stats hide-version
9291 stats scope .
9292 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9296
9297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9298 backend private_monitoring
9299 stats enable
9300 stats uri /admin?stats
9301 stats refresh 5s
9302
9303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9304
9305
9306stats scope { <name> | "." }
9307 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009309 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009310 Arguments :
9311 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9312 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9313 section in which the statement appears.
9314
9315 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9316 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9317 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9318 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9319 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9320 exists.
9321
9322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9324 unobvious parameters.
9325
9326 Example :
9327 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9328 backend public_www
9329 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9330 stats enable
9331 stats hide-version
9332 stats scope .
9333 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009334 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009335 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9336 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9337
9338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9339 backend private_monitoring
9340 stats enable
9341 stats uri /admin?stats
9342 stats refresh 5s
9343
9344 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9345
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009346
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009347stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009348 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009350 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009351
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009352 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009353 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9354
9355 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9356 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9357
9358 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9359 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009361
9362 Example :
9363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9364 backend private_monitoring
9365 stats enable
9366 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9367 stats uri /admin?stats
9368 stats refresh 5s
9369
9370 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9371 global section.
9372
9373
9374stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009375 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9377 yes | yes | yes | yes
9378 Arguments : none
9379
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009380 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009381 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9382 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9383 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9384 - IP (socket, server)
9385 - cookie (backend, server)
9386
9387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009389 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009390
9391 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9392
9393
9394stats show-node [ <name> ]
9395 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009398 Arguments:
9399 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9400 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9401
9402 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9403 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009404 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009405
9406 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9407 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9408 unobvious parameters.
9409
9410 Example:
9411 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9412 backend private_monitoring
9413 stats enable
9414 stats show-node Europe-1
9415 stats uri /admin?stats
9416 stats refresh 5s
9417
9418 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9419 section.
9420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009421
9422stats uri <prefix>
9423 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009425 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009426 Arguments :
9427 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9428 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9429 query string.
9430
9431 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9432 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9433 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9434 possible to reach it in the application.
9435
9436 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009437 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009438 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9439 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9440 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9441 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9442
9443 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9444 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9445 an address or a port to statistics only.
9446
9447 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9448 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9449 unobvious parameters.
9450
9451 Example :
9452 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9453 backend public_www
9454 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9455 stats enable
9456 stats hide-version
9457 stats scope .
9458 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009459 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009460 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9461 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9462
9463 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9464 backend private_monitoring
9465 stats enable
9466 stats uri /admin?stats
9467 stats refresh 5s
9468
9469 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9470
9471
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009472stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9473 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009475 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009476
9477 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009478 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009479 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009480 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009481 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9482
9483 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9484 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9485 the "stick-table" statement.
9486
9487 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9488 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9489 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9490 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9491 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9492
9493 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9494 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9495 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9496 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9497 transformation rules.
9498
9499 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9500 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9501 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9502 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9503 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9504 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9505 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9506
9507 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9508 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9509 ACL based conditions.
9510
9511 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9512 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9513 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9514 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9515
9516 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9517 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9518 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9519 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9520
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009521 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9522 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009523 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009524
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009525 Example :
9526 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9527 # last 30 minutes
9528 backend pop
9529 mode tcp
9530 balance roundrobin
9531 stick store-request src
9532 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9533 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9534 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9535
9536 backend smtp
9537 mode tcp
9538 balance roundrobin
9539 stick match src table pop
9540 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9541 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9542
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009543 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009544 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009545
9546
9547stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9548 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9550 no | no | yes | yes
9551
9552 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9553 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9554 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9555 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009557 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9558 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009559 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009561 Examples :
9562 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009563 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009564
9565 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9566 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9567 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9568
9569
9570 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9571 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9572 backend http
9573 mode http
9574 balance roundrobin
9575 stick on src table https
9576 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9577 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9578 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9579
9580 backend https
9581 mode tcp
9582 balance roundrobin
9583 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9584 stick on src
9585 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9586 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9587
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009588 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009589
9590
9591stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9592 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9594 no | no | yes | yes
9595
9596 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009597 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009598 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009599 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009600 server is selected.
9601
9602 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9603 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9604 the "stick-table" statement.
9605
9606 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9607 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9608 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9609 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9610 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9611 address.
9612
9613 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9614 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9615 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9616 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9617 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9618 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9619 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9620 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9621 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9622 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9623
9624 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9625 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9626 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9627 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9628 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9629 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9630 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9631
9632 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9633 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9634 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9635 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9636
9637 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9638 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9639 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9640 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9641 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9642 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009643 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9644 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9645 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9646 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9647 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9648 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009649
9650 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9651 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9652 the request.
9653
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009654 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9655 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009656 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009657
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009658 Example :
9659 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9660 # last 30 minutes
9661 backend pop
9662 mode tcp
9663 balance roundrobin
9664 stick store-request src
9665 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9666 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9667 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9668
9669 backend smtp
9670 mode tcp
9671 balance roundrobin
9672 stick match src table pop
9673 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9674 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9675
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009676 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009677 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009678
9679
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009680stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009681 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9682 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009683 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009685 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009686
9687 Arguments :
9688 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9689 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9690 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9691 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9692
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009693 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9694 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9695 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9696 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9697
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009698 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9699 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9700 instance.
9701
9702 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9703 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9704 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9705 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9706 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9707 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009708 to 32 characters.
9709
9710 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9711 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9712 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009713 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009714 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9715 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009716
9717 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009718 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9719 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009720 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9721 increase.
9722
9723 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009724 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9725 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9726 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009727
9728 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9729 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9730 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9731 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009732 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009733 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9734 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9735 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9736 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9737 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9738 parameter (see below).
9739
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009740 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9741 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9742 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9743 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9744 soft restart.
9745
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009746 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9747 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009748
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009749 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9750 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9751 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9752 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009753 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009754 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009755 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9756 if not expiration delay is specified.
9757
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009758 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9759 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9760 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9761 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009762 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9763 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9764 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9765 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9766 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9767 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9768 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9769 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9770 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9771 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9772 types and their arguments.
9773
9774 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9775 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9776 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9777 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9778
9779 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9780 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9781 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009783
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009784 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9785 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9786 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009787 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009788 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009790
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009791 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9792 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9793 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9794 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9795
9796 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9797 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9798 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9799 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9800 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9801 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9802
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009803 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9804 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9805 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9806 they were received.
9807
9808 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9809 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9810 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9811 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9812 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9813
9814 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9815 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9816 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9817 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9818 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9819
9820 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9821 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9822 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9823
9824 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9825 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9826 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9827 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9828 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9829
9830 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9831 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9832 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9833 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9834 the client side.
9835
9836 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9837 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9839 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9840 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9841 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9842 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9843
9844 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9845 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9846 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9847 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9848 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9849 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009850 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009851
9852 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9853 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9854 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9855 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9856 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9857 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9858
9859 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009860 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009861 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9862 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9863
9864 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9865 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9866 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9867 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9868 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9869 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9870 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9871 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9872 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9873 recommended for better fairness.
9874
9875 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009876 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009877 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9878 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9879
9880 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9881 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9882 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9883 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9884 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9885 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9886 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9887 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9888 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9889 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009890
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009891 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9892 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009893 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9894 reference it.
9895
9896 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9897 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009898 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9899 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9900 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009901
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009902 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9903 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9904 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9905 something that can be ignored.
9906
9907 Example:
9908 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9909 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9910 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9911 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9912
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009913 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009914 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009915
9916
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009917stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009918 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 no | no | yes | yes
9921
9922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009923 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009924 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009926 server is selected.
9927
9928 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9929 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9930 the "stick-table" statement.
9931
9932 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9933 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9934 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9935 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9936
9937 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9938 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9939 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9940 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9941 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9942 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009943 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009944 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9945 rules.
9946
9947 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9948 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9949 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9950 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9951 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9952 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9953 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9954
9955 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9956 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9957 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9958 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9959
9960 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9961 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9962 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9963 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9964 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9965 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009966 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9967 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9968 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9969 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9970 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9971 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9972 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9973 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9974 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009975
9976 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9977
9978 Example :
9979 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9980 backend https
9981 mode tcp
9982 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009983 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009984 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009985
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009986 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9987 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9988
9989 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9990 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9991 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9992
9993 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9994 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009995
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009996 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9997 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9998 # at offset 44.
9999
10000 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10001 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10002
10003 # Learn on response if server hello.
10004 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010005
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010006 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10007 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10008
10009 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10010 extraction.
10011
10012
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010013tcp-check comment <string>
10014 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10015 it fails.
10016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10017 yes | no | yes | yes
10018
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010019 Arguments :
10020 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10021 rule fails.
10022
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010023 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10024 user-friendly error reporting.
10025
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010026 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10027 "tcp-check expect".
10028
10029
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010030tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10031 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
10032 [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010033 Opens a new connection
10034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010035 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010036
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010037 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010038 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10039
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010040 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010041 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010042
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010043 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010044 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10045 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010046 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010047
10048 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010049
10050 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10051
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010052 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10053
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010054 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10055
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010056 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10057
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010058 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10059 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10060 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10061 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10062
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010063 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010064
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010065 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10066 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10067 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10068
10069 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10070 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10071 of the sequence.
10072
10073 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10074 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10075 do.
10076
10077 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10078 unset-var or comment rules.
10079
10080 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010081 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10082 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10083 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10084 option tcp-check
10085 tcp-check connect
10086 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10087 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10088 tcp-check send \r\n
10089 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10090 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10091 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10092 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10093 tcp-check send \r\n
10094 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10095 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10096
10097 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10098 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010099 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010100 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10101 tcp-check connect port 143
10102 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10103 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10104
10105 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10106
10107
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010108tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010109 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010110 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010111 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010112 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010114 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010115
10116 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010117 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10118
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010119 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10120 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10121 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10122 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10123 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10124 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10125 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10126 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10127 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10128 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10129
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010130 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010131 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10132 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010133 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10134 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10135 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10136
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010137 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10138 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10139 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
10140 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
10141 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
10142 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
10143 By default "L7OK" is used.
10144
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010145 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10146 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10147 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
10148 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
10149 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
10150 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
10151
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010152 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010153 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
10154 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
10155 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
10156 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
10157 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10158
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010159 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10160 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10161 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10162 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10163
10164 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10165 informational message reported in logs if an error
10166 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10167 log-format string.
10168
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010169 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10170 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10171 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10172 followed by some converters.
10173
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010174 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10175 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10176 with the usual backslash ('\').
10177 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010178 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010179 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10180 used upper or lower case.
10181
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010182 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10183
10184 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10185 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10186 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10187 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10188 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10189 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10190 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10191 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10192
10193 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10194 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10195 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10196 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10197 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10198 expression.
10199
10200 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10201 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10202 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10203 this exact hexadecimal string.
10204 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10205
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010206 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10207 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10208 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10209 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10210 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10211 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10212 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10213 size.
10214
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010215 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10216 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10217 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10218 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10219 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10220 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10221 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10222 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10223 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10224 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10225 the null character.
10226
10227 Examples :
10228 # perform a POP check
10229 option tcp-check
10230 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10231
10232 # perform an IMAP check
10233 option tcp-check
10234 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10235
10236 # look for the redis master server
10237 option tcp-check
10238 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010239 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010240 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10241 tcp-check expect string role:master
10242 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10243 tcp-check expect string +OK
10244
10245
10246 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10247 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10248
10249
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010250tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010251 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010253 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010254
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010255 Arguments :
10256 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10257
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010258 <data> the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10259 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010260
10261 Examples :
10262 # look for the redis master server
10263 option tcp-check
10264 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10265 tcp-check expect string role:master
10266
10267 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10268 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10269
10270
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010271tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010272 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010273 tcp health check
10274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010275 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010276
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010277 Arguments :
10278 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010279
10280 <hexstring> test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
10281 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10282 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact hexadecimal
10283 string. Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary
10284 protocols.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010285
10286 Examples :
10287 # redis check in binary
10288 option tcp-check
10289 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10290 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10291
10292
10293 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10294 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10295
10296
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010297tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010298 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010300 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010301
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010302 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010303 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10304 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10305 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10306 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10307 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10308 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10309 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10310 and '-'.
10311
10312 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10313
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010314 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010315 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10316
10317
10318tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010319 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010321 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010322
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010323 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010324 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10325 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10328 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10330 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10331 and '-'.
10332
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010333 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010334 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10335
10336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010337tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10338 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10340 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010342 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10343 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010345 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010346
10347 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10348 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010349 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10350 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10351 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10352 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10353 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10354 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010356 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10357 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10358 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10359 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010360
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010361 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010362 - accept :
10363 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10364 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10365 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010367 - reject :
10368 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10369 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10370 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10371 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10372 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10373 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10374 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10375 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10376 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10377 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10378 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010379 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010380
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010381 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10382 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10383 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10384 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10385 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10386 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10387 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10388 hosts.
10389
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010390 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10391 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10392 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10393 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10394 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10395 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10396 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10397 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10398
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010399 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10400 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10401 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10402 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10403 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10404 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10405 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10406 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10407 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010408 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10409 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010410
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010411 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010412 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010413 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10414 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10415 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010416 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010417 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10418 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10419 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10420 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10421 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10422 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10423 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10424 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010426 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010427 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010428 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010429 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010430 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10431 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10432 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10435 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10436 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10437 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010438
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010439 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10440 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10441 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10442 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10443 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010444 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10445 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10446 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10447 layer7 information is extracted.
10448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010449 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10450 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10451 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10452 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10453 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010454
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010455 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10456 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10457 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10458 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10459
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010460 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10461 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10462 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10463 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10464
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010465 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10466 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10467 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10468 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10469 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010470
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010471 - set-src <expr> :
10472 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10473 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10474 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010475 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010477 Arguments:
10478 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10479 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010480
10481 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010482 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10483
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010484 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10485 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010486
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010487 - set-src-port <expr> :
10488 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10489 expression.
10490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010491 Arguments:
10492 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10493 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010494
10495 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010496 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10497
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010498 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10499 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10500 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010501
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010502 - set-dst <expr> :
10503 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10504 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10505 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10506 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10507 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10508
10509 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10510 followed by some converters.
10511
10512 Example:
10513
10514 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10515 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10516
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010517 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10518 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10519
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010520 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10521 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10522 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10523 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10524
10525
10526 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10527 followed by some converters.
10528
10529 Example:
10530
10531 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10532
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010533 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10534 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10535 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10536
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010537 - "silent-drop" :
10538 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010539 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010540 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10541 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10542 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10543 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10544 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010545 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10546 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010547 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10548 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010549 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010550 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10551 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10552 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10553 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010555 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10556 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10557 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010559 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10560 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10561 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010562
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010563 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010564 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010565 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010567 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10568 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10569 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010571 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010572 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10573 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010574
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010575 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10576
10577 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10578
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010579 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10580
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010581 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010582
10583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010584tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10585 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010587 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010588 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010589 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10590 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010592 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010594 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010595 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10596 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10597 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10598 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010600 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10601 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10602 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10603 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010604 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10605 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10606 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10607 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10608 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10609 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010610 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010611 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010613 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10614 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10615 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10616 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010617
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010618 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010619 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010620 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010621 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10622 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010623 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010624 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010625 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010626 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010628 - set-dst <expr>
10629 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010630 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010631 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010632 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010633 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010634 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010636 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10637 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010638 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10639 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010640
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010641 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10642 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10643 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10644 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10645 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10646 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010648 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010649 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10650 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010652 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010653 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10654 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10655 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10656 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010657 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10658 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10659 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010660
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010661 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010662 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10663 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10664 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010665
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010666 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10667 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10668
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010669 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010670 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10671 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010672
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010673 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10674 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010678 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010680 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010681 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10682 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010684 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10685 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010686
10687 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10688 followed by some converters.
10689
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010690 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10691 <var-name>.
10692
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010693 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10694 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10695 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10696 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10697 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10698
10699 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10700 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10701 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10702 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10703 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10704 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10705 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10706 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10707 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10708 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10709 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10710
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010711 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10712 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10713 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10714 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10715 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10716
10717 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10718
10719 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10720
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010721 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10722 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10723 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10724 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10725 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10726 evaluated.
10727
10728 Example:
10729 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10730
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010731 Example:
10732
10733 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010734 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010735
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010736 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010737 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10738 # and reject everything else.
10739 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10740 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010741 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010742 tcp-request content reject
10743
10744 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010745 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10746 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10747 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010748 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010749
10750 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10751 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10752 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010753 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010754 tcp-request content reject
10755
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010756 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010757 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010758 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010759 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010760 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10761 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010762
10763 Example:
10764 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10765 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010766 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010768 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010769 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010770
10771 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010772 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010773 # protecting all our sites
10774 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010775 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10776 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010777 ...
10778 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10779
10780 backend http_dynamic
10781 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010782 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010783 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010784 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010785 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010786 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010787 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010789 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010790
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010791 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10792 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010793
10794
10795tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10796 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010798 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010799 Arguments :
10800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10802 as explained at the top of this document.
10803
10804 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10805 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10806 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10807 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10808 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10809
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010810 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10811 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10812 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10813 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10814
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010815 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10816 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010817 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010818 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010819 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10820 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10821 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10822 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010823
10824 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10825 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10826 it pass through unaffected.
10827
10828 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10829 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10830 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010831 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10833 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010834 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10835 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10836 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010838 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010839 "timeout client".
10840
10841
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010842tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10843 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10845 no | no | yes | yes
10846 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010847 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10848 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010849
10850 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010852 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010853 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10854 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010855 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10856 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010857
10858 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10859
10860 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10861 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10862 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10863 inserted.
10864
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010865 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010866 - accept :
10867 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10868 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10869 the rules evaluation.
10870
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010871 - close :
10872 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10873 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10874 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10875 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10876 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10877 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010878 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010879 protocols.
10880
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010881 - reject :
10882 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10883 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010884 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010886 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10887 Sets a variable.
10888
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010889 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10890 Unsets a variable.
10891
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010892 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10893 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10894 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10895 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10896
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010897 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10898 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10899 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10900 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10901
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010902 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10903 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10904 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10905 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10906 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010907
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010908 - "silent-drop" :
10909 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010910 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010911 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10912 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10913 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10914 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10915 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10917 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010918 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10919 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010921 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10922 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10923 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10924 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10925
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010926 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10927 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10928
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010929 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10930 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10931 for changing the default action to a reject.
10932
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010933 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10934 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10935 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10936 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010937 period.
10938
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010939 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10940 declared inline.
10941
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010942 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10943 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010944 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010945 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10946 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010947 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010948 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010949 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10951 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010953 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10954 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010955
10956 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10957 followed by some converters.
10958
10959 Example:
10960
10961 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10962
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010963 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10964 <var-name>.
10965
10966 Example:
10967
10968 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10969
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010970 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10971 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10972 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10973 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10974 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10975
10976 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10977
10978 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10979
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010980 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10981
10982 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10983
10984
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010985tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10986 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10988 no | yes | yes | no
10989 Arguments :
10990 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10991 below.
10992
10993 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10994
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010996 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10997 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10998 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10999 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11000 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11001 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11002 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011003 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011004 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11005 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11006 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11007 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11008 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11009 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11010 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11011 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11012 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11013 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11014 instead.
11015
11016 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11017 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11018 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11019 rules which may be inserted.
11020
11021 Several types of actions are supported :
11022 - accept : the request is accepted
11023 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11024 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11025 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011026 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011027 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011028 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011029 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011030 - silent-drop
11031
11032 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11033 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11034 sections for a complete description.
11035
11036 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11037 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11038 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11039
11040 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11041 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11042 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11043 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11044 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11045
11046 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11047 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11048
11049 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11050 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11051 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11052
11053 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11054 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11055 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11056
11057 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11058 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11059 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11060
11061 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11062 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11063 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11064
11065 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11066
11067 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11068
11069
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011070tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11071 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11073 no | no | yes | yes
11074 Arguments :
11075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11077 as explained at the top of this document.
11078
11079 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11080
11081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011082timeout check <timeout>
11083 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11084 established.
11085
11086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11087 yes | no | yes | yes
11088 Arguments:
11089 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11090 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11091 as explained at the top of this document.
11092
11093 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11094 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011095 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011096 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011097 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11098 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11099 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011100
11101 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11102 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11103
11104 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11105 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011106 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011107
11108 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11109 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11110 forget about it.
11111
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011112 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11113 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011114
11115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011116timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011117 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11119 yes | yes | yes | no
11120 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11123 as explained at the top of this document.
11124
11125 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11126 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11127 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011128 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11129 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11130 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11131 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011132 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11133 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11134 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011135 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011136 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11138 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011139 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11140 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011141
11142 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11144 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11145 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011146 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011147 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11148
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011149 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011150
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011151 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011153
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011154timeout client-fin <timeout>
11155 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11157 yes | yes | yes | no
11158 Arguments :
11159 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11160 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11161 as explained at the top of this document.
11162
11163 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11164 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11165 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11166 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11167 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11168 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11169 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011170 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11171 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11172 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011173
11174 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11175 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11176 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11177
11178 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11179
11180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011181timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011182 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11184 yes | no | yes | yes
11185 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11188 as explained at the top of this document.
11189
11190 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011191 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011192 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011193 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011194 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11195 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011196
11197 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11198 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11199 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11200 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011201 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011202 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11203
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011204 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011206
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011207timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11208 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11210 yes | yes | yes | yes
11211 Arguments :
11212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11214 as explained at the top of this document.
11215
11216 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11217 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11218 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11219 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11220 once the request has started to present itself.
11221
11222 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11223 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11224 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11225 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11226 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11227
11228 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11229 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11230 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11231 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11232
11233 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11234 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011236 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11237 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011238 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011239
11240 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11241 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11242 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11243 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11244
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011245 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11246 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011247 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11248
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011249 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11250
11251
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011252timeout http-request <timeout>
11253 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11259 as explained at the top of this document.
11260
11261 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11262 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11263 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11264 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11265 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11266 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11267 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011268 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11269 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11270 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11271 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011272 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011273 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11274 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011275
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011276 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11277 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11278 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11279 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11280 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011281 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011282
11283 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11284 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011286 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11287 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11288
11289 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011290 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11291 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11292 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011293
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011294 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011295 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011296
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011297
11298timeout queue <timeout>
11299 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11301 yes | no | yes | yes
11302 Arguments :
11303 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11304 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11305 as explained at the top of this document.
11306
11307 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11308 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11309 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11310 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11311 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11312
11313 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11314 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11315 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11316 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11317
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011318 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011319
11320
11321timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011322 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11324 yes | no | yes | yes
11325 Arguments :
11326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11328 as explained at the top of this document.
11329
11330 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11331 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11332 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11333 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11334 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11335 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11336 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11337
11338 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11339 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11340 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11341 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11342 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011343 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011344 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011345 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11346 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011347 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11348 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011349
11350 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11351 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11352 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11353 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011354 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011355 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11356
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011357 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011358
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011359
11360timeout server-fin <timeout>
11361 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11363 yes | no | yes | yes
11364 Arguments :
11365 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11367 as explained at the top of this document.
11368
11369 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11370 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11371 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11372 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11373 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11374 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11375 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11376 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11377 situations, it should not be needed.
11378
11379 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11380 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11381 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11382
11383 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11384
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011385
11386timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011387 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11389 yes | yes | yes | yes
11390 Arguments :
11391 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11392 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11393 as explained at the top of this document.
11394
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011395 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11396 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11397 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011398
11399 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11400 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11401 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11402 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011403 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011404
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011405 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011406
11407
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011408timeout tunnel <timeout>
11409 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11411 yes | no | yes | yes
11412 Arguments :
11413 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11414 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11415 as explained at the top of this document.
11416
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011417 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011418 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11419 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11420 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011421 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11422 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011423 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11424 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11425 specified.
11426
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011427 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11428 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11429 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11430 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11431 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11432 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11433 state.
11434
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011435 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11436 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11437 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11438 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011439 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011440
11441 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11442 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11443 forget about it.
11444
11445 Example :
11446 defaults http
11447 option http-server-close
11448 timeout connect 5s
11449 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011450 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011451 timeout server 30s
11452 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11453
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011454 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011455
11456
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011457transparent (deprecated)
11458 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011460 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011461 Arguments : none
11462
11463 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11464 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11465 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11466 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11467 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11468 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11469 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11470 appropriate server.
11471
11472 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11473
11474 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11475 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11476
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011477 See also: "option transparent"
11478
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011479unique-id-format <string>
11480 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11482 yes | yes | yes | no
11483 Arguments :
11484 <string> is a log-format string.
11485
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011486 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11487 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11488 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11489 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011490
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011491 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11492 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11493 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11494 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11495 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11496 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11497 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11498 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011499
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011500 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11501 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011502
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011503 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011504
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011505 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011506
11507 will generate:
11508
11509 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11510
11511 See also: "unique-id-header"
11512
11513unique-id-header <name>
11514 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11516 yes | yes | yes | no
11517 Arguments :
11518 <name> is the name of the header.
11519
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011520 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11521 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011522
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011523 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011524
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011525 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011526 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11527
11528 will generate:
11529
11530 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11531
11532 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011533
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011534use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011535 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11537 no | yes | yes | no
11538 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011539 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11540 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011541
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011542 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11543 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011544
11545 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11546 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11547 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011548 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011550 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11551 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011552
11553 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11554 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11555 assign the backend.
11556
11557 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11558 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11559 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11560 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11561 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11562 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11563
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011564 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011565 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011566 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11567 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11568 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11569
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011570 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11571 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11572 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11573 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11574 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11575 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11576 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11577 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11578 cannot be forced from the request.
11579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011580 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011581 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11582 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11583
11584 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11585 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011586
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011587use-fcgi-app <name>
11588 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11590 no | no | yes | yes
11591 Arguments :
11592 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11593
11594 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011595
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011596use-server <server> if <condition>
11597use-server <server> unless <condition>
11598 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11600 no | no | yes | yes
11601 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011602 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11603 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011604
11605 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11606
11607 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11608 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11609 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11610
11611 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11612 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11613 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11614 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11615 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11616 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11617 matches will assign the server.
11618
11619 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11620 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11621 with the next rules until one matches.
11622
11623 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11624 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11625 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11626 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11627
11628 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11629 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11630 stripped.
11631
11632 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11633 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11634 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11635 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11636
11637 Example :
11638 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11639 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11640 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11641 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11642 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11643 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011644 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011645 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11646 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11647
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011648 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11649 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11650 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11651 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11652 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11653 and we fall back to load balancing.
11654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011655 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011656
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011657
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100116585. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011659--------------------------
11660
11661The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11662depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11663settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11664written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11665described in this section.
11666
11667
116685.1. Bind options
11669-----------------
11670
11671The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11672as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11673no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11674parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11675while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11676provided immediately after the setting name.
11677
11678The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11679
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011680accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11681 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11682 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11683 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11684 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11685 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11686 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11687 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11688 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11689 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011690 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11691 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11692 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011694accept-proxy
11695 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011696 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11697 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011698 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11699 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11700 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11701 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011702 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011703 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11704 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011705 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11706 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011707
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011708allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011709 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011710 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011711 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011712 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11713 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011714
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011715alpn <protocols>
11716 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11717 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11718 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011719 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011720 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011721 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11722 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11723 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11724 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11725 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11726 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11727 preference, like below :
11728
11729 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011730
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011731backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011732 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011733 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11734
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011735curves <curves>
11736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11737 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11738 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11739 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11740 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11741 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11742
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011743ecdhe <named curve>
11744 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011745 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11746 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011747
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011748ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11750 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11751 client's certificate.
11752
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011753ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11754 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11755 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11756 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11757 error is ignored.
11758
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011759ca-sign-file <cafile>
11760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11761 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11762 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11763 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11764 'generate-certificates' for details.
11765
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011766ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11768 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11769 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11770 'generate-certificates' for details.
11771
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011772ca-verify-file <cafile>
11773 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11774 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11775 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11776 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11777 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11778
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011779ciphers <ciphers>
11780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11781 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011782 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011783 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011784 information and recommendations see e.g.
11785 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11786 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11787 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11788
11789ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11791 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11792 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11793 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011794 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11795 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011796
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011797crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11799 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11800 to verify client's certificate.
11801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011802crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11804 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11805 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11806 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11807 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011808 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11809 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011810
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011811 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11812 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11813
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011814 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11815 are loaded.
11816
11817 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011818 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11819 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11820 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11821 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11822 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11823 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11824 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011825 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011826
11827 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11828 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11829 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11830 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011831 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11832 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011833
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011834 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011835
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011836 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011837 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011838 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11839 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011840 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11841 clients).
11842
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011843 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11844 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11845 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11846 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11847 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11848 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11849 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11850 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11851 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11852 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11853 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11854 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11855 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11856
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011857 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11858 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11859 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11860 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11861 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11862
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011863 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11864 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11865 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11866 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011867
11868 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11869 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11870 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11871 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11872 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11873 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11874 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11875 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11876 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11877
11878 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11879
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011880 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011881 a cert bundle.
11882
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011883 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011884 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11885 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11886 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11887 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11888 provide multi-cert support.
11889
11890 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11891
11892 Filename | CN | SAN
11893 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11894 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011895 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011896 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11897 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11898
11899 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11900 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11901 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11902 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011903 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11904 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11905 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011906
11907 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11908 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11909
11910 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11911 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11912 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11913
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011914crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011916 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011917 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011918 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011919
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011920crt-list <file>
11921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011922 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11923 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011924
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011925 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11926
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011927 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11928 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11929 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11930 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011931
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011932 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11933 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11934 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11935 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11936 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11937 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11938 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11939 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011940
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011941 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011942 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011943 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11944 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11945 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011946
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011947 crt-list file example:
11948 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011949 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011950 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011951 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011953defer-accept
11954 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11955 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11956 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011958 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11959 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11960 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11961 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11962 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11963 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11964 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11965
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011966expose-fd listeners
11967 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11968 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011969 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11970 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011972
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011973force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011974 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011975 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011976 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011977 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011978
11979force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011980 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011981 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011982 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011983
11984force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011985 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011986 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011987 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011988
11989force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011990 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011991 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011992 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011993
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011994force-tlsv13
11995 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11996 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011997 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011998
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011999generate-certificates
12000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12001 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12002 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12003 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12004 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12005 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12006 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12007 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12008 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12009 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12010 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12011
12012 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12013 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012014 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012015 certificate is used many times.
12016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012017gid <gid>
12018 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12019 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12020 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12021 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12022 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12023
12024group <group>
12025 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12026 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12027 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12028 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12029 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12030
12031id <id>
12032 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12033 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12034 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12035 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12036
12037interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012038 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12039 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12040 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12041 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12042 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12043 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012044 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12045 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12046 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12047 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12048 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12049 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012050
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012051level <level>
12052 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12053 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12054 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012055 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012056 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12057 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12058 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012060 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012061 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012062 all counters).
12063
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012064severity-output <format>
12065 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12066 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12067 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12068 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12069 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12070 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12071 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12072 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12073 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12074 rfc5424 convention.
12075
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012076maxconn <maxconn>
12077 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12078 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12079 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12080 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12081 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12082 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12083 eat all memory.
12084
12085mode <mode>
12086 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12087 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12088 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12089 UNIX sockets.
12090
12091mss <maxseg>
12092 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12093 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12094 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12095 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12096 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12097 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12098 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12099 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12100 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12101 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12102 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12103
12104name <name>
12105 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12106 page.
12107
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012108namespace <name>
12109 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12110 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12111 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12112 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12113
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012114nice <nice>
12115 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12116 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12117 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12118 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12119 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12120 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12121 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12122 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12123 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12124 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12125 one for an RDP socket.
12126
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012127no-ca-names
12128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12129 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012130 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012131
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012132no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012134 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012135 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012136 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012137 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12138 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012139
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012140no-tls-tickets
12141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12142 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12143 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012144 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12145 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012146 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12147 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12148 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012149
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012150no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012152 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012153 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012154 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012155 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12156 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012157
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012158no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012160 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012161 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012162 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012163 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12164 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012165
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012166no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012168 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012169 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012170 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012171 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12172 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012173
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012174no-tlsv13
12175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12176 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12177 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12178 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012179 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12180 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012181
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012182npn <protocols>
12183 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12184 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12185 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012186 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012187 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012188 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12189 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12190 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12191 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12192 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012193
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012194prefer-client-ciphers
12195 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12196 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12197 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012198 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12199 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12200 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012201
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012202process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012203 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012204 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012205 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012206 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12207 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12208 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12209 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012210 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012211 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12212 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12213 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12214 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12215 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012216
12217 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12218
12219 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12220 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12221 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12222 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12223 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12224 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12225 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12226 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012227
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012228proto <name>
12229 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12230 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12231 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12232 in haproxy -vv.
12233 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12234 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012235 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012236 h2" on the bind line.
12237
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012238ssl
12239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012240 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012241 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12242 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012243 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12244 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012245
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012246ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12247 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12248 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12249 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12250
12251ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12252 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12253 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12254 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12255
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012256strict-sni
12257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12258 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12259 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12260 See the "crt" option for more information.
12261
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012262tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012263 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012264 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12265 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012266 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012267 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12268 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12269 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12270 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12271 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12272 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12273 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12274
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012275tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012276 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012277 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12278 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12279 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12280 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12281 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12282 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12283 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012284 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12285 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12286 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012287
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012288tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12289 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012290 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12291 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12292 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12293 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12294 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12295 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12296 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12297 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12298 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12299 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012300 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12301 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012303transparent
12304 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12305 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12306 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12307 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12308 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12309 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12310 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12311 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12312 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12313 so check for support with your vendor.
12314
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012315v4v6
12316 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12317 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12318 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12319 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012320 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012321
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012322v6only
12323 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12324 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12325 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012326 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12327 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012328
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012329uid <uid>
12330 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12331 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12332 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12333 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12334 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12335
12336user <user>
12337 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12338 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12339 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12340 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12341 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12342
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012343verify [none|optional|required]
12344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12345 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12346 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12347 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12348 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012349 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12350 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12351 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12352 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200123545.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012355------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012357The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12358which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12359arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12360settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12361after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12362Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12363address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012365 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012366 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012367
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012368Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12369keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012371The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012372
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012373addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012374 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012375 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12376 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12377 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12378 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12379 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012380
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012381agent-check
12382 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012383 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012384 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12385 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12386 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012387
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012388 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012389 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012390 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12391 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12392 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012394 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12395 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12396 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12397 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12398 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012399
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012400 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012401 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012402
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012403 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12404 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12405 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012406
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012407 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12408 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12409 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012410
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012411 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12412 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12413 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12414 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12415 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012416 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012417 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012418
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012419 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12420 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012421
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012422 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12423 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12424 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12425 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12426 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12427 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12428 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12429 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12430 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012431
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012432 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12433 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012434 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12435 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12436 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012437 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012438
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012439 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012440 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012441
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012442agent-send <string>
12443 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12444 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12445 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12446 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12447 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12448
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012449agent-inter <delay>
12450 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12451 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12452
12453 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12454 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12455 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12456 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12457 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12458 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12459 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12460 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12461 of backends use the same servers.
12462
12463 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12464
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012465agent-addr <addr>
12466 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12467
12468 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12469 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12470 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12471 hostname, it will be resolved.
12472
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012473agent-port <port>
12474 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12475
12476 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12477
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012478allow-0rtt
12479 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012480 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12481 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012482
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012483alpn <protocols>
12484 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12485 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12486 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012487 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012488 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12489 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12490 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12491 now obsolete NPN extension.
12492 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12493 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12494
12495 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012497backup
12498 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12499 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12500 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12501 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012502 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12503 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012504
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012505ca-file <cafile>
12506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12507 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12508 server's certificate.
12509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012510check
12511 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012512 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12513 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12514 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12515 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12516 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12517 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12518 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012519 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12520 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012521 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12522 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012523
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012524check-send-proxy
12525 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12526 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12527 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12528 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12529 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12530 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12531 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12532
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012533check-alpn <protocols>
12534 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12535 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12536 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12537
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012538check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012539 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012540 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12541 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012542
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012543check-ssl
12544 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12545 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12546 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12547 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012548 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012549 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12550 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012551 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012552 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12553 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012554
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012555check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012556 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012557 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12558 for normal traffic.
12559
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012560ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12562 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12563 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012564 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12565 information and recommendations see e.g.
12566 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12567 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12568 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012569
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012570ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12572 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12573 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12574 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012575 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12576 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12577 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012579cookie <value>
12580 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12581 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12582 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12583 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12584 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12585 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12586 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12587
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012588crl-file <crlfile>
12589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12590 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12591 to verify server's certificate.
12592
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012593crt <cert>
12594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12595 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12596 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12597 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12598 certificate request.
12599
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012600disabled
12601 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12602 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12603 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12604 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12605 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012606 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012607
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012608enabled
12609 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12610 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12611 default value.
12612 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12613 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012615error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012616 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12617 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12618 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012620 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012622fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012623 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12624 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12625 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12626
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012627force-sslv3
12628 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12629 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012630 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012631 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012632
12633force-tlsv10
12634 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012635 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012636 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012637
12638force-tlsv11
12639 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012640 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012641 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012642
12643force-tlsv12
12644 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012645 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012646 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012647
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012648force-tlsv13
12649 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12650 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012651 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012653id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012654 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12655 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12656 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012657
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012658init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12659 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12660 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012661 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012662 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12663 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12664 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12665 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12666 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12667 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12668 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12669 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12670 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012671 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012672 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12673 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12674 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12675 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12676 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12677 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012678 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012679
12680 Example:
12681 defaults
12682 # never fail on address resolution
12683 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012685inter <delay>
12686fastinter <delay>
12687downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012688 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12689 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12690 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12691 between checks depending on the server state :
12692
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012693 Server state | Interval used
12694 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12695 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12696 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12697 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12698 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12699 or yet unchecked. |
12700 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12701 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12702 | "inter" otherwise.
12703 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012705 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12706 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12707 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12708 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012709 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12710 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12711 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12712 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12713 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012715maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012716 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12717 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012718 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12719 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012720 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12721 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12722 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12723 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12724
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012725 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12726 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12727 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12728 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12729 than 50 concurrent requests.
12730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012731maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012732 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12733 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12734 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12735 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12736 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12737 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12738 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12739
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012740max-reuse <count>
12741 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12742 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12743 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12744 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12745 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12746 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12747 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12748 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012750minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012751 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12752 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12753 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12754 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12755 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12756 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012757 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012758 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012759
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012760namespace <name>
12761 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12762 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12763 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12764 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12765
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012766no-agent-check
12767 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12768 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12769 default value.
12770 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12771 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12772
12773no-backup
12774 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12775 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12776 default value.
12777 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12778 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12779
12780no-check
12781 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12782 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12783 default value.
12784 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12785 "default-server" "check" setting.
12786
12787no-check-ssl
12788 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12789 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12790 default value.
12791 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12792 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12793
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012794no-send-proxy
12795 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12796 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12797 default value.
12798 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12799 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12800
12801no-send-proxy-v2
12802 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12803 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12804 default value.
12805 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12806 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12807
12808no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12809 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12810 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12811 default value.
12812 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12813 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12814
12815no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12816 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12817 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12818 default value.
12819 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12820 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12821
12822no-ssl
12823 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12824 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12825 default value.
12826 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12827 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12828
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012829no-ssl-reuse
12830 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12831 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12832 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12833 and for paranoid users.
12834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012835no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012836 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12837 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012838 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012839
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012840 Supported in default-server: No
12841
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012842no-tls-tickets
12843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12844 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12845 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012846 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12847 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012848 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12849 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12850 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012851 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012852
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012853no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012854 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012855 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12856 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012857 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12858 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012859 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012860
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012861 Supported in default-server: No
12862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012863no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012864 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012865 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12866 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012867 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12868 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012869 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012870
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012871 Supported in default-server: No
12872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012873no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012874 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012875 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12876 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012877 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12878 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012879 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012880
12881 Supported in default-server: No
12882
12883no-tlsv13
12884 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12885 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12886 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12887 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12888 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012889 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012890
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012891 Supported in default-server: No
12892
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012893no-verifyhost
12894 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12895 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12896 default value.
12897 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12898 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012899
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012900no-tfo
12901 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12902 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12903 default value.
12904 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12905 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12906
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012907non-stick
12908 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12909 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12910 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12911
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012912npn <protocols>
12913 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12914 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12915 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012916 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012917 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12918 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12919 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12920
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012921observe <mode>
12922 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12923 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12924 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12925 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12926 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12927 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012928 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012929
12930 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012932on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012933 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12934 Currently, four modes are available:
12935 - fastinter: force fastinter
12936 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12937 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12938 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12939 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12940
12941 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12942
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012943on-marked-down <action>
12944 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12945 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012946 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12947 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12948 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12949 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12950 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12951 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12952 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12953 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012954
12955 Actions are disabled by default
12956
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012957on-marked-up <action>
12958 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12959 Currently one action is available:
12960 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12961 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12962 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12963 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012964 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12965 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012966 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12967 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12968
12969 Actions are disabled by default
12970
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012971pool-max-conn <max>
12972 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12973 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12974 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12975 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12976 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12977 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12978
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012979pool-purge-delay <delay>
12980 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012981 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012982 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012984port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012985 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12986 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12987 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12988 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12989 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12990 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12991
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012992proto <name>
12993
12994 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12995 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12996 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12997 reported in haproxy -vv.
12998 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12999 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013001redir <prefix>
13002 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13003 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13004 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13005 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13006 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13007 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13008 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13009 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013010 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013011 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013012 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13013 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13014 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13015 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13016
13017 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013019rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013020 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13021 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13022 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13023
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013024resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13025 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13026 server.
13027
13028 Available options:
13029
13030 * allow-dup-ip
13031 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13032 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13033 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13034 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13035 For such case, simply enable this option.
13036 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13037
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013038 * ignore-weight
13039 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13040 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13041 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13042
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013043 * prevent-dup-ip
13044 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13045 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13046 same fqdn.
13047 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13048
13049 Example:
13050 backend b_myapp
13051 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13052 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13053 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13054
13055 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13056 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13057 it
13058 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13059 different address
13060
13061 Default value: not set
13062
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013063resolve-prefer <family>
13064 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13065 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13066 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13067 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13068
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013069 Default value: ipv6
13070
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013071 Example:
13072
13073 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013074
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013075resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013076 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013077 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013078 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013079 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13080 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013081 configured network, another address is selected.
13082
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013083 Example:
13084
13085 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013086
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013087resolvers <id>
13088 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13089 hostname.
13090
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013091 Example:
13092
13093 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013094
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013095 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013096
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013097send-proxy
13098 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13099 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13100 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13101 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013102 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13103 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13104 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13105 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13106 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13107 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13108 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13109 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13110 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13111 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013112 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13113 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013114
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013115send-proxy-v2
13116 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13117 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13118 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13119 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013120 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13121 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13122 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13123 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013124
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013125proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013126 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13127 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13128
13129 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13130 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13131 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13132 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13133 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13134 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13135 connection is supported).
13136 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13137 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13138 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13139 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13140 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13141 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13142 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013143
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013144send-proxy-v2-ssl
13145 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13146 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13147 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13148 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13149 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13150 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13151 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013152 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13153 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013154
13155send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13156 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13157 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13158 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13159 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13160 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13161 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13162 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13163 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13165 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013167slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013168 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13169 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13170 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13171 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13172 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13173 parameters :
13174
13175 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13176 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13177
13178 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13179 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13180 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13181 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13182
13183 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13184 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13185 seen as failed.
13186
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013187sni <expression>
13188 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13189 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13190 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13191 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013192 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13193 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013194 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013195 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13196 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013197
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013198source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013199source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013200source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013201 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13202 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13203 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13204 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13205
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013206 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13207 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13208 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13209 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13210 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13211 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13212 server.
13213
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013214 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13215 specifying the source address without port(s).
13216
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013217ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013218 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13219 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13220 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13221 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13222 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13223 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013224 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13225 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013226
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013227ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13228 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13229 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13230 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13231
13232ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13233 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13234 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13235 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13236
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013237ssl-reuse
13238 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13239 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13240 default value.
13241 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13242 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13243
13244stick
13245 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13246 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13247 default value.
13248 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13249 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013250
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013251socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013252 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013253 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13254 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13255
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013256tcp-ut <delay>
13257 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13258 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13259 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013261 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13262 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13263 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13264 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13265 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13266 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13267 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13268 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13269 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13270
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013271tfo
13272 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13273 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13274 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13275 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13276 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013277 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013279track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013280 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13281 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13282 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13283 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013284 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13285
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013286tls-tickets
13287 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13288 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13289 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013290 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13291 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13292 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013294 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013295
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013296verify [none|required]
13297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013298 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013299 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13300 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013301 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013302 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13303 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13304 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13305 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13306 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13307 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13308 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13309 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013310
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013311verifyhost <hostname>
13312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013313 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13314 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13315 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13316 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13317 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13318 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13319 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13320 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013322weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13324 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13325 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013326 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13327 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13328 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13329 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13330 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13331 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013332
13333
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13335-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013336
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013337HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13338using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13339configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013340This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13341can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13342workload.
13343This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13344resolution at run time.
13345Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13346carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13347
13348
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133495.3.1. Global overview
13350----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013351
13352As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13353different steps of the process life:
13354
13355 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13356 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13357 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13358
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013359 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13360 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013361
13362A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13363 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13364 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13365 resolution to know this new IP.
13366
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013367When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013368HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013369SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13370from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13371will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13372will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013373
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013374A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013375 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013376 first valid response.
13377
13378 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13379 servers return an error.
13380
13381
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200133825.3.2. The resolvers section
13383----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013384
13385This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013386HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13387contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013388
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013389When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13390uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13391is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13392answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13393
13394When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013395used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013396
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013397 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13398 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13399 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013400
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013401 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13402 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013403
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013404 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13405 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13406 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013407
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013408For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13409following scenarios are possible:
13410
13411 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13412 ignored
13413
13414 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13415 applied
13416
13417 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13418 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13419
13420 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13421 retries the query with a new type
13422
13423 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13424 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013425
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013426As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13427a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013428<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013429
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013430
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013431resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013432 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013433
13434A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13435
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013436accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013437 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013438 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013439 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13440 by RFC 6891)
13441
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013442 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13443
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013444nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13445 DNS server description:
13446 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13447 <ip> : IP address of the server
13448 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13449
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013450parse-resolv-conf
13451 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13452 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13453 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13454
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013455hold <status> <period>
13456 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13457 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013458 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013459 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013460 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13461 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13462 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13463
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013464 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013465
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013466resolve_retries <nb>
13467 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13468 giving up.
13469 Default value: 3
13470
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013471 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13472 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13473 type.
13474
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013475timeout <event> <time>
13476 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13477 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13478 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013479 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13480 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013481 Default value: 1s
13482 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013483 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013484 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013485 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13486 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13487
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013488 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013489
13490 resolvers mydns
13491 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13492 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013493 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013494 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013495 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013496 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013497 hold other 30s
13498 hold refused 30s
13499 hold nx 30s
13500 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013501 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013502 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013503
13504
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200135056. Cache
13506---------
13507
13508HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13509(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13510RAM.
13511
13512The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13513this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13514
13515If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13516independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13517when we try to allocate a new one.
13518
13519The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13520
13521It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13522"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13523for more details.
13524
13525When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13526replaced by "<CACHE>".
13527
13528
135296.1. Limitation
13530----------------
13531
13532The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13533
13534- If the response is not a 200
13535- If the response contains a Vary header
13536- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13537- If the response is not cacheable
13538
13539- If the request is not a GET
13540- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13541- If the request contains an Authorization header
13542
13543
135446.2. Setup
13545-----------
13546
13547To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13548the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13549
13550
135516.2.1. Cache section
13552---------------------
13553
13554cache <name>
13555 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13556 size of cache is mandatory.
13557
13558total-max-size <megabytes>
13559 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13560 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13561
13562max-object-size <bytes>
13563 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13564 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13565 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13566
13567max-age <seconds>
13568 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13569 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13570 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13571 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13572 default.
13573
13574
135756.2.2. Proxy section
13576---------------------
13577
13578http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13579 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13580 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13581 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13582 after this one.
13583
13584http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13585 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13586 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13587 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13588 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13589
13590
13591Example:
13592
13593 backend bck1
13594 mode http
13595
13596 http-request cache-use foobar
13597 http-response cache-store foobar
13598 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13599
13600 cache foobar
13601 total-max-size 4
13602 max-age 240
13603
13604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13606----------------------------------
13607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013608HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013609client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13610The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13611these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13612but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13613data called patterns.
13614
13615
136167.1. ACL basics
13617---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013618
13619The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13620content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13621from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13622simple :
13623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013625 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13627 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013629The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13630adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013631
13632In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013634 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013635
13636This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13637Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13638and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013639an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13640conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13641as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13642are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013643
13644ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13645'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13646which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13647
13648There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13649performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13652specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13653this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013654methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13655ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656
13657Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13658 - boolean
13659 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13660 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13661 - string
13662 - data block
13663
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013664Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13665converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13666would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13667The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13668which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13669
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013670Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13671keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13672fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13673which are summarized in the table below :
13674
13675 +---------------------+-----------------+
13676 | Sample or converter | Default |
13677 | output type | matching method |
13678 +---------------------+-----------------+
13679 | boolean | bool |
13680 +---------------------+-----------------+
13681 | integer | int |
13682 +---------------------+-----------------+
13683 | ip | ip |
13684 +---------------------+-----------------+
13685 | string | str |
13686 +---------------------+-----------------+
13687 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13688 +---------------------+-----------------+
13689
13690Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13691matching method, see below.
13692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13694 - boolean
13695 - integer or integer range
13696 - IP address / network
13697 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13698 - regular expression
13699 - hex block
13700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013701The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13702
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013703 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13704 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013706 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013707 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013708 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013709 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013711The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13712read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13713if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13714lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13715will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13716beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13717a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13718lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13719exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13720
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013721The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13722parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13723ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13724a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13725check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13726
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013727The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13728socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13729file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13732loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13733
13734 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13735
13736In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13737the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13738case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13739as well.
13740
13741The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13742sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13743do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13744methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13745is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13748default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13749that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13750string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13751
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013752The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13753By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13754string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13755resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13756server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013757waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013758flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13759function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13762sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13763be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013764
13765 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13766 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13768 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13769 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13770 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013771
13772 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13773 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013775
13776 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013778
13779 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013781
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013782 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013783 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13784
13785 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13786 binary or string samples.
13787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13789 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13792 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13793 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13796 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013798 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13799 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13802 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013804 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13805 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013806 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13809 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13810 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013811
13812For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13813request, it is possible to do :
13814
13815 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13816
13817In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13818buffer, one would use the following acl :
13819
13820 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13821
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013822On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13823possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13824
13825 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13828criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13829method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13830to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13831criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13832the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013834If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013835the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13836For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013838 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13839 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13840 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13841 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013842
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013843
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013844The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13845types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13846combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13847brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13848default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850 +-------------------------------------------------+
13851 | Input sample type |
13852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013853 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13855 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013857 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013859 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013861 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013863 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013865 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013867 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013869 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013871 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013873 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013875 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013877 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13879 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013881
13882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138837.1.1. Matching booleans
13884------------------------
13885
13886In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13887Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13888When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13889that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13890
13891Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13892return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13893"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13894
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138967.1.2. Matching integers
13897------------------------
13898
13899Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13900enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13901to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13902
13903Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13904matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13905lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013906
13907For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13908unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13909representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13910
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013911As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13912two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13913instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13914ranges and operators.
13915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013916For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013917operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13918Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13919of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013920
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013921Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013922
13923 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13924 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13925 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13926 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13927 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013929For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013930
13931 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13932
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013933This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13934
13935 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139387.1.3. Matching strings
13939-----------------------
13940
13941String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13942different forms :
13943
13944 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013945 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946
13947 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013948 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949
13950 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13951 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13952
13953 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13954 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13955
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013956 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13958 matches.
13959
13960 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13961 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13962 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013963
13964String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13965exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13966characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13967string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13968to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013969before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013970
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013971Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13972(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13973Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13974
13975Example:
13976 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13977 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13978
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13981---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013982
13983Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13984they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13985possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13986passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13987the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013988the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13989match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013990
13991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13993-------------------------------------
13994
13995It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13996not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13997a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13998to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13999digits may be used upper or lower case.
14000
14001Example :
14002 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14003 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14004
14005
140067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14007---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014008
14009IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14010netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14011within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014012host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014013difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14014at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14015does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14016parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014017
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014018The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14019abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14020
14021 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14022 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14023 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14024 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14025 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14026 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14027 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14028 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14029
14030Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14031192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14032
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014033IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14034Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14035trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14036IPv6 patterns.
14037
14038HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14039following situations :
14040 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14041 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14042 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14043 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14044 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14045 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14046 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14047 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14048 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14049 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051
140527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14053----------------------------------
14054
14055Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14056combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14057
14058 - AND (implicit)
14059 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14060 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14067indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14070"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14071requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14072is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14073
14074 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014075 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14076 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14077 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078
14079To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14080and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14081
14082 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14083 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14084 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14085 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14089 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14090 use_backend www if host_www
14091
14092It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14093expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14094be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14095the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14096
14097 The following rule :
14098
14099 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014100 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101
14102 Can also be written that way :
14103
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014104 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105
14106It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14107to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14108simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14109sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14110good use is the following :
14111
14112 With named ACLs :
14113
14114 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14115 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14116 monitor fail if site_dead
14117
14118 With anonymous ACLs :
14119
14120 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14121
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014122See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14123keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124
14125
141267.3. Fetching samples
14127---------------------
14128
14129Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14130against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14131sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14132ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14133of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14134available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14135
14136This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14137Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14138compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14139deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14140
14141The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14142matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14143method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14144indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14145
14146As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14147when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14148mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14149the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14150ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14151
14152Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14153multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14154when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14156are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14158all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14159
14160Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14161 - name
14162 - name(arg1)
14163 - name(arg1,arg2)
14164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014165
141667.3.1. Converters
14167-----------------
14168
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014169Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14170of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14171is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14172was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014173has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014174unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14175
14176These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14177sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14178the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014179support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014180
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014181A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14182support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14183supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14184(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14185bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014188
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001418951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14190 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14191 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14192 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14193 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14194 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14195
14196 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014197 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14198 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014199 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14200 frontend http-in
14201 bind *:8081
14202 default_backend servers
14203 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14204 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14205
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014206add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014207 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014208 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014209 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14210 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014211 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014212 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14213 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14214 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14215 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014216 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014217 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014218
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014219aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14220 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14221 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14222 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14223 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14224 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14225 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14226
14227 Example:
14228 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14229 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14230
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014231and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014232 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014233 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014234 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14235 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14239 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14240 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014241 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014242 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014243
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014244b64dec
14245 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14246 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14247
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014248base64
14249 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014250 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014251 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14252
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014253bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014254 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014255 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014256 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014257 presence of a flag).
14258
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014259bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14260 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14261 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014262 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014263
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014264concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14265 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14266 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14267 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14268 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14269 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14270 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14271 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14272 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14273 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14274 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014275 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14276 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14277 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14278 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014279
14280 Example:
14281 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14282 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14283 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014284 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014285 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14286
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014287cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014288 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14289 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014290
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014291crc32([<avalanche>])
14292 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14293 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14294 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14295 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14296 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14297 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14298 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14299 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14300 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14301 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014302 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14303
14304crc32c([<avalanche>])
14305 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14306 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14307 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14308 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14309 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14310 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14311 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14312 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014313
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014314cut_crlf
14315 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14316 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14317 updated.
14318
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014319da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014320 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14321 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14322 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14323 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014324 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014325 configuration language.
14326
14327 Example:
14328 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014329 bind *:8881
14330 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014331 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014332
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014333debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14334 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14335 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14336 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14337 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14338 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14339 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14340 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14341 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14342 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14343 printable sample types.
14344
14345 Example:
14346 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014347
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014348div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014349 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14350 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014351 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014352 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14353 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014354 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014355 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14356 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14357 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14358 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014359 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014360 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014361
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014362djb2([<avalanche>])
14363 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14364 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14365 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14366 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14367 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14368 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14369 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014370 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14371 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014372
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014373even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014374 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014375 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14376
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014377field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14378 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14379 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14380 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14381 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14382 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14383 fields.
14384
14385 Example :
14386 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14387 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14388 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14389 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14390 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014391
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014392hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014394 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014396 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014397
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014398hex2i
14399 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014400 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014401
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014402htonl
14403 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14404 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14405 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14406 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14407
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014408http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014409 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14410 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014411 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14412 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14413 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14414 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14415 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14416 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14417 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14418 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014420in_table(<table>)
14421 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14422 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14423 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014424 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014425 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14426
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014427ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14428 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014429 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014430 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14431 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14432 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14433 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14434 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014435
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014436json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014437 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014438 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014439 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014440 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14441 of errors:
14442 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14443 bytes, ...)
14444 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14445 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14446
14447 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14448 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14449 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14450 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14451 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14452 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014453 - "ascii" : never fails;
14454 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14455 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014456 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014458 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14459 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14460
14461 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014462 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014463
14464 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014465 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014466 capture request header user-agent len 150
14467 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014468
14469 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14470 GET / HTTP/1.0
14471 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14472
14473 Output log:
14474 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014476language(<value>[,<default>])
14477 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14478 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14479 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14480 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14481 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14482 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14483 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14484 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14485 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014486 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014487 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14488 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014489
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014490 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014492 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14493 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014495 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14496 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14497 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14498 use_backend spanish if es
14499 use_backend french if fr
14500 use_backend english if en
14501 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014502
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014503length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014504 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14505 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14506 type. The result is of type integer.
14507
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014508lower
14509 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14510 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14511 type. The result is of type string.
14512
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014513ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14514 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14515 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14516 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14517 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14518 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14519 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14520
14521 Example :
14522
14523 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014524 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014525 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14526
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014527ltrim(<chars>)
14528 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14529 representation of the input sample.
14530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014531map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14532map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14533map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14534 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14535 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14536 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14537 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14538 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14539 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14540 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14541 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014543 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14544 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14545 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014546
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014547 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014548 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014550 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14551 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14552 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14553 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014554 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14555 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014556 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14557 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14558 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14559 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14560 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14561 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14562 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14563 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014564 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14565 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14566 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014567 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14568 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14569 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14570 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14571 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014572
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014573 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14574 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14575 the corresponding match text.
14576
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014577 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14578 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14579 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14580 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14581 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014583 Example :
14584
14585 # this is a comment and is ignored
14586 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14587 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14588 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14589 | | | `---------- value
14590 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14591 | `---------------------------- key
14592 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14593
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014594mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014595 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14596 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014597 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014598 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014599 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014600 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14601 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14602 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14603 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014605 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014606
14607mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014608 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014609 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14610 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014611 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014612 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014613 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014614 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14615 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14616 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14617 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014619 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014620
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014621nbsrv
14622 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14623 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14624 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14625 map lookup.
14626
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014627neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014628 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14629 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14630 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14631 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014632
14633not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014634 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014635 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014636 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014637 absence of a flag).
14638
14639odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014640 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014641 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14642
14643or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014644 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014645 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014646 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14647 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14650 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014654 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014655
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014656protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14657 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14658 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14659 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14660 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14661 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14662 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14663 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14664 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14665 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14666 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14667 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14668
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014669regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014670 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14671 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14672 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14673 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14674 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14675 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14676 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14677 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14678 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014679 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14680 of characters with other ones.
14681
14682 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14683 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14684 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14685 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14686 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14687 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014688
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014689 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014690
14691 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14692 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14693 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014694 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014695
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014696 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14697 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14698
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014699 # capture groups and backreferences
14700 # both lines do the same.
14701 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14702 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14703
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014704capture-req(<id>)
14705 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14706 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14707
14708 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014709 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14710 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014711
14712capture-res(<id>)
14713 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14714 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14715
14716 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014717 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14718 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014719
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014720rtrim(<chars>)
14721 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14722 of the input sample.
14723
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014724sdbm([<avalanche>])
14725 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14726 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14727 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14728 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14729 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14730 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14731 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014732 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14733 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014734
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014735set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014736 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14737 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14738 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014739 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014740 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14741 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014742 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014743 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014746 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014747
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014748sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014749 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014750 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14751
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014752sha2([<bits>])
14753 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14754 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14755
14756 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14757 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14758
14759 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14760 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14761
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014762srv_queue
14763 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14764 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14765 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14766 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14767 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14768
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014769strcmp(<var>)
14770 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14771 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14772 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14773 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14774 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14775 shorter).
14776
14777 Example :
14778
14779 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14780 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14781 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14782
14783
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014784sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014785 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14786 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014787 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014788 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14789 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014790 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014791 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14792 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014793 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014794 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14795 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014797 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014798
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014799table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14802 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14803 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14804 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14805 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14806
14807
14808table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14812 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14813 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14814 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14815
14816table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014820 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14821 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14822
14823table_conn_cur(<table>)
14824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14826 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14827 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14828 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14829
14830table_conn_rate(<table>)
14831 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14832 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14833 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14834 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14835 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14836
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014837table_gpt0(<table>)
14838 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14839 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14840 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14841 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14842 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14843
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014844table_gpc0(<table>)
14845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14848 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14849 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14850
14851table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14855 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14856 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14857 sample fetch keyword.
14858
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014859table_gpc1(<table>)
14860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14863 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14864 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14865
14866table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14870 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14871 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14872 sample fetch keyword.
14873
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014874table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014878 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14879 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14880
14881table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14884 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14885 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14886 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14887 keyword.
14888
14889table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014893 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14894 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14895
14896table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14899 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14900 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14901 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14902 keyword.
14903
14904table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014908 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14909 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14910 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14911 keyword.
14912
14913table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014917 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14918 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14919 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14920 keyword.
14921
14922table_server_id(<table>)
14923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14926 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14927 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14928 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14929
14930table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014934 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14935 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14936 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14937 keyword.
14938
14939table_sess_rate(<table>)
14940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14943 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14944 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14945 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14946 keyword.
14947
14948table_trackers(<table>)
14949 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14950 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14951 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14952 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14953 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14954 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14955 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14956 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14957 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14958 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14959
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014960upper
14961 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14962 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14963 type. The result is of type string.
14964
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014965url_dec([<in_form>])
14966 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14967 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14968 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14969 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14970 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14971 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014972
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014973ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014974 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014975 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14976 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14977 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014978 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14979 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14980 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14981 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014982 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014983 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14984 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014985
14986 Example:
14987 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14988 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14989
14990 message Point {
14991 int32 latitude = 1;
14992 int32 longitude = 2;
14993 }
14994
14995 message PPoint {
14996 Point point = 59;
14997 }
14998
14999 message Rectangle {
15000 // One corner of the rectangle.
15001 PPoint lo = 48;
15002 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15003 PPoint hi = 49;
15004 }
15005
15006 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15007 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15008 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15009
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015010 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15011 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015012 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015013 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15014
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015015 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015016
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015017 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015018
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015019 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015020 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15021 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15022
15023 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15024 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15025 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15026
15027 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15028 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15029 interpret the previous binary sample.
15030
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015031
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015032unset-var(<var name>)
15033 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15034 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15035 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15036 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15037 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15038 response),
15039 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15040 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15041 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15042 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15043
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015044utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15045 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15046 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15047 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15048 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15049 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15050 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15051
15052 Example :
15053
15054 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015055 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015056 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15057
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015058word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15059 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15060 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15061 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015062 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015063 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15064 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15065
15066 Example :
15067 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15068 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15069 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15070 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15071 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015072 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015073
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015074wt6([<avalanche>])
15075 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15076 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15077 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15078 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15079 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15080 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15081 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015082 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15083 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015084
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015085xor(<value>)
15086 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015087 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015088 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015089 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015090 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015091 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15092 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015093 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015094 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15095 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015096 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015097 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015098
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015099xxh32([<seed>])
15100 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15101 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15102 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15103 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15104 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15105 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15106 as cryptographically secure.
15107
15108xxh64([<seed>])
15109 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15110 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15111 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15112 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15113 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15114 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15115 as cryptographically secure.
15116
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015117
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151187.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119--------------------------------------------
15120
15121A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15122not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15123"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15124The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15125
15126always_false : boolean
15127 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15128 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15129
15130always_true : boolean
15131 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15132 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15133
15134avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015135 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15137 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15138 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15139 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15140 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15141 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15142 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15143 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15144 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15145 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15146 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15147 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15148 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015151 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15152 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15153 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15154 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015155 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15156
15157be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15158 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15159 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15160 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15161 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15162 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015163 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15164 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015165
15166 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15167 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15168 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15172 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15173 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015174 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15176 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015177
15178 Example :
15179 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15180 backend dynamic
15181 mode http
15182 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15183 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015184
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015186 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15187 of the string.
15188
15189bool(<bool>) : bool
15190 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15191 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015195 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15197 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015198
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015199 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015200 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015201 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15202
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015203 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15204 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015205
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015206 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015207 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015209 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015210 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015212 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015213
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015214 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15215 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015217 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015218
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015219cpu_calls : integer
15220 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15221 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15222 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15223 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15224 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15225 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15226
15227cpu_ns_avg : integer
15228 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15229 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15230 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15231 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15232 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15233 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15234 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15235 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15236 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15237 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15238 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15239
15240cpu_ns_tot : integer
15241 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15242 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15243 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15244 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15245 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15246 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15247 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15248 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15249 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15250 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15251 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15252 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15253 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15254
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015255date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015256 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015257
15258 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15259 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15260 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015261 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15262
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015263 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15264 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15265 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15266 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15267 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15268
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015269 Example :
15270
15271 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15272 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015273
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015274 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15275 # millisecond granularity
15276 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15277
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015278date_us : integer
15279 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15280 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15281 from the same timeval structure.
15282
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015283distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15284 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15285 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15286 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15287 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15288 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15289 list of supported tokens.
15290
15291distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15292 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15293 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15294 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15295 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15296 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15297 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15298 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15299 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15300 supported tokens.
15301
15302 Example :
15303 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15304 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15305 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15306 # send large files to the big farm
15307 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15308
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015309env(<name>) : string
15310 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15311 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15312 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15313 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15314 certain way.
15315
15316 Examples :
15317 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15318 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15319
15320 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15321 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15324 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015325 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15326 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15328 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015329 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15331 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015332
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015333fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15334 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15335 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15336 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15339 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15340 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15341 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15342 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15343 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15344 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15345 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15346 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015347
15348 Example :
15349 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15350 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15351 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15352 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15353 frontend mail
15354 bind :25
15355 mode tcp
15356 maxconn 100
15357 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15358 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15359 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15360 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015361
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015362hostname : string
15363 Returns the system hostname.
15364
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015365int(<integer>) : signed integer
15366 Returns a signed integer.
15367
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015368ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15369 Returns an ipv4.
15370
15371ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15372 Returns an ipv6.
15373
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015374lat_ns_avg : integer
15375 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15376 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15377 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15378 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15379 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15380 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15381 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15382 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15383 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15384 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15385 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15386 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15387 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15388 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15389
15390lat_ns_tot : integer
15391 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15392 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15393 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15394 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15395 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15396 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15397 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15398 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15399 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15400 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15401 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15402 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15403 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15404 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15405 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15406 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15407 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15408 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15409 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15410
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015411meth(<method>) : method
15412 Returns a method.
15413
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015414nbproc : integer
15415 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15416 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15417 and debugging purposes.
15418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15421 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15422 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015423 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15424 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15425 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015426
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015427prio_class : integer
15428 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15429 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15430 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15431
15432prio_offset : integer
15433 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15434 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15435 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15436 set-priority-offset".
15437
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015438proc : integer
15439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15440 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15441 debugging purposes.
15442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015444 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15445 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15446 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15448 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15449 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15450 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15451 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15452
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015453rand([<range>]) : integer
15454 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15455 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15456 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15457 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15458 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15459
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015460uuid([<version>]) : string
15461 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15462 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15463 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15467 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15468 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15469 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15470 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015471 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15472 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15473
15474srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15475 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15476 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15477 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15478 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15479 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15480 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15481 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15482
15483 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15484 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485
15486srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15487 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15488 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15489 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015490 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15492 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15493 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15494
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015495srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15497 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15498 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15499 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15500 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15501 fetch methods.
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15504 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15505 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015506 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15508 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015509 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510 overloading servers).
15511
15512 Example :
15513 # Redirect to a separate back
15514 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15515 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15516 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15517
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015518stopping : boolean
15519 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15520 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15521 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15522
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015523str(<string>) : string
15524 Returns a string.
15525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15527 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15528 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15529
15530table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15531 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15532 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15533 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15534
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015535thread : integer
15536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15537 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15538 and debugging purposes.
15539
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015540var(<var-name>) : undefined
15541 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015542 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15543 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015544 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015547 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015548 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15549 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015550 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015551 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015552
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155537.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554----------------------------------
15555
15556The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15557closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15558methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15559sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15560TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015561the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15562counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015563"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15564used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15565can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15566Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15567table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15568tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15569currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015571bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015572 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15573 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15574 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576be_id : integer
15577 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15578 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15579
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015580be_name : string
15581 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15582 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584dst : ip
15585 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15586 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15587 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15588 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015589 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15590 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15591 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15592 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15593 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15594 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595
15596dst_conn : integer
15597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15598 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15599 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15600 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15601 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15602 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15603 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15604 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015605
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015606dst_is_local : boolean
15607 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15608 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15609 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15610 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015611 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015612 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15613 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15614 it only once per connection.
15615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616dst_port : integer
15617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15618 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15619 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15620 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15621 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15622 an HTTP header.
15623
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015624fc_http_major : integer
15625 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15626 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15627 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15628
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015629fc_pp_authority : string
15630 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15631 if any.
15632
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015633fc_pp_unique_id : string
15634 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15635 if any.
15636
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015637fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15638 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15639 header.
15640
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015641fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15642 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15643 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15644 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15645 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15646 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15647 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15648
15649fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15650 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15651 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15652 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15653 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15654 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15655 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15656
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015657fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015658 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15659 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15660 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15661 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15662
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015663fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015664 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15665 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15666 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15667 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15668
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015669fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015670 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15671 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15672 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15673 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15674
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015675fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015676 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15677 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15678 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15679 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15680
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015681fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015682 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15683 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15684 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15685 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15686
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015687fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015688 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15689 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15690 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15691 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15692
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015693fe_defbe : string
15694 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15695 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697fe_id : integer
15698 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015699 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15701
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015702fe_name : string
15703 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15704 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15705 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015707sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015708sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15709sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15710sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015711 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15712 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15713 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015715sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015716sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15717sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15718sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015719 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15720 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15721 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15722
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015723sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015724sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15725sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15726sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015727 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15728 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015729 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15730 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15731 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015732
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015733 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015734 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15735 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015736 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15737 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15738 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015739 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15740 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15741
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015742sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15743sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15744sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15745sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15746 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15747 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15748 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15749 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15750 when a first ACL was verified.
15751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015752sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015753sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15754sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15755sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015756 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015757 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015759sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015760sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15761sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15762sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015763 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15764 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15765 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015767sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015768sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15769sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15770sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015771 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15772 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15773 See also src_conn_rate.
15774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015775sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015776sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15777sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15778sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015779 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015780 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015781
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015782sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15783sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15784sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15785sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15786 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15787 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15788
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015789sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15790sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15791sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15792sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15793 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15794 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015796sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015797sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15798sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15799sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015800 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15801 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15802 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015803 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15804 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15805 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015806
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015807sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15808sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15809sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15810sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15811 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15812 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15813 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15814 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15815 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15816 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015818sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015819sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15820sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15821sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015822 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015823 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15824 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015826sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015827sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15828sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15829sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015830 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15831 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15832 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15833 src_http_err_rate.
15834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015835sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015836sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15837sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15838sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015839 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015840 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15841 src_http_req_cnt.
15842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015843sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015844sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15845sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15846sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015847 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15848 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15849 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15850 src_http_req_rate.
15851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015852sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015853sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15854sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15855sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015856 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015857 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15858 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15859 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15860 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015861
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015862 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015863 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15864 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015865 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15866
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015867sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15868sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15869sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15870sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15871 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15872 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15873 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15874 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15875 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015877sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015878sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15879sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15880sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015881 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15882 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15883 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015885sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015886sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15887sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15888sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015889 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15890 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15891 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015893sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015894sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15895sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15896sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015897 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015898 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15899 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15900 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015901 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015902 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015904sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015905sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15906sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15907sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015908 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15909 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15910 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15911 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15912 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015913 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015914
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015915sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015916sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15917sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15918sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015919 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15920 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15921 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015923sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015924sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15925sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15926sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015927 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15928 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015929 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015930 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15931 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15933 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15934 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936so_id : integer
15937 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15938 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15939 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015940
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015941so_name : string
15942 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15943 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15944 strings instead of integers.
15945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15949 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15950 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015951 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15952 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15953 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015954 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15955 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15956 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15957 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15958 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15959 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15960 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015961
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015962 Example:
15963 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15964 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15967 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15968 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15969 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015970 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15973 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15974 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015975 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015976 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15979 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15980 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15981 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15982 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15983 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15984 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015985
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015986 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015987 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15988 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15989 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15990 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015991 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015992 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15993 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15994
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015995src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15996 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15997 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15998 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15999 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16000 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16001 was verified.
16002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016004 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016006 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016007 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016010 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16012 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016013 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16016 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16017 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16018 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016019 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016021src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016022 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016024 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016025 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016026
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016027src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16028 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16029 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16030 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16031 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16032
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016033src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16034 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16035 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16036 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16037 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016040 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016042 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16043 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016044 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16045 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16046 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016047
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016048src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16049 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16050 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16051 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16052 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16053 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16054 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16055 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016060 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016061 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16065 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16066 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16067 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16068 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016069 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016072 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16074 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016075 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16078 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16079 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16080 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016081 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016082 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16085 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16086 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16087 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016088 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16090 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016091
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016092 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016093 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016094 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016095 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016096
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016097src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16098 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16099 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16100 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16101 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16102 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16103 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16104
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016105src_is_local : boolean
16106 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16107 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16108 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16109 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016110 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016111 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16112 once per connection.
16113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016115 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16116 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16117 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16118 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16119 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016122 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16123 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16124 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16125 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16126 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128src_port : integer
16129 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16130 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16131 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16132 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016135 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016136 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16137 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16138 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016139 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16142 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16143 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16144 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16145 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016146 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16149 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16150 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16151 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16152 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16153 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16154 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16155 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16156 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016157
16158 Example :
16159 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16160 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16161 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16162 listen ssh
16163 bind :22
16164 mode tcp
16165 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016166 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016167 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016168 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170srv_id : integer
16171 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16172 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16173 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016174
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016175srv_name : string
16176 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16177 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
16178 debugging.
16179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16184closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16185when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16186usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016187future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016188
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001618951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16190 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16191 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16192 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16193 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16194 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16195
16196 Example :
16197 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16198 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16199 # the request.
16200 frontend http-in
16201 bind *:8081
16202 default_backend servers
16203 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16204 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16205
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016206ssl_bc : boolean
16207 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16208 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
16209 other a server with the "ssl" option.
16210
16211ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16212 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
16213 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16214
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016215ssl_bc_alpn : string
16216 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16217 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016218 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016219 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16220 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16221 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16222 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16223 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16224 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
16225
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016226ssl_bc_cipher : string
16227 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
16228 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16229
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016230ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16231 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16232 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16233 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16234
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016235ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16236 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16237 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
16238 session or a TLS ticket.
16239
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016240ssl_bc_npn : string
16241 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16242 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016243 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016244 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16245 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16246 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16247 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16248 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16249
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016250ssl_bc_protocol : string
16251 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16252 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16253
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016254ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016255 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016256 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16257 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016258
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016259ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16260 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16261 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16262 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16263
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016264ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16265 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16266 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16267 if session was reused or not.
16268
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016269ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16270 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16271 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16272 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16273 BoringSSL.
16274
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016275ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16276 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16277 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16280 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16281 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16282 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16283 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16284 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16287 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16288 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16289 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16290 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016291
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016292ssl_c_der : binary
16293 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16294 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16295 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016297ssl_c_err : integer
16298 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16299 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16300 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16301 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16302 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016303
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016304ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016305 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16306 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16307 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16308 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16309 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16310 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16311 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16312 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016313 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16314 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16315 LDAP v3.
16316 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16317 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319ssl_c_key_alg : string
16320 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16321 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16322 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324ssl_c_notafter : string
16325 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16326 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16327 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329ssl_c_notbefore : string
16330 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16331 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16332 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016333
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016334ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16336 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16337 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16338 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16339 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16340 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16341 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16342 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016343 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16344 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16345 LDAP v3.
16346 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16347 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349ssl_c_serial : binary
16350 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16351 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16352 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16355 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16356 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16357 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016358 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16359 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16360
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016361 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016362 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016364ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16365 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16366 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16367 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016369ssl_c_used : boolean
16370 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16371 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373ssl_c_verify : integer
16374 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16375 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16376 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16377 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379ssl_c_version : integer
16380 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16381 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016382
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016383ssl_f_der : binary
16384 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16385 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16386 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16387
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016388ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16390 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16391 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16392 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016393 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16395 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16396 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016397 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16398 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16399 LDAP v3.
16400 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16401 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016403ssl_f_key_alg : string
16404 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16405 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16406 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408ssl_f_notafter : string
16409 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16410 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16411 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413ssl_f_notbefore : string
16414 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16415 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16416 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016417
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016418ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016419 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16420 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16421 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16422 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16423 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16424 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16425 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16426 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016427 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16428 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16429 LDAP v3.
16430 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16431 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433ssl_f_serial : binary
16434 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16435 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16436 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016437
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016438ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16439 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16440 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16441 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016443ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16444 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16445 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16446 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448ssl_f_version : integer
16449 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16450 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16451
16452ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016453 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16454 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16455 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 Example :
16458 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16459 listen http-https
16460 bind :80
16461 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16462 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16463
16464ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16465 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16466 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16467
16468ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016469 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016470 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16471 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16472 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16473 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16474 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16475 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16476 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16477 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479ssl_fc_cipher : string
16480 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16481 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016482
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016483ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16484 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16485 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016486 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016487
16488ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16489 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16490 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016491 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016492
16493ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16494 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16495 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16496 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016497 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016498 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016499
16500ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16501 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16502 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016503 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016504
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016505ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16506 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16507 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16508 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016511 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16512 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016513 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16514 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16515 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16516 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016517
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016518ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16519 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16520 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16521 wait until the handshake happened.
16522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16524 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016525 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16526 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016527 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016528 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016529
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016530ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016531 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016532 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16533 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016536 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016537 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16538 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16539 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16540 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16541 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16542 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16543 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016545ssl_fc_protocol : string
16546 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16547 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016548
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016549ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016550 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016551 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16552 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016553
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016554ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16555 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16556 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16557 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16560 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16561 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16562 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16563 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016564
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016565ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16566 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16567 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16568 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16569 BoringSSL.
16570
16571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572ssl_fc_sni : string
16573 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16574 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16575 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16576 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16577 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16578
16579 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16580 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16581 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016582 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016583 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16587 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16590 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16591 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016592
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016593
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165947.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16598sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16599only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16600For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16601be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16602can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16603sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16604for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16605content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016607payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016608 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16610 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016612payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16613 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016616
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016617req.hdrs : string
16618 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16619 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16620 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16621 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16622
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016623req.hdrs_bin : binary
16624 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16625 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16626 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16627 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16628 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16629 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16630
16631 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16632
16633 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16634 str: <int:length><bytes>
16635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636req.len : integer
16637req_len : integer (deprecated)
16638 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16639 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16640 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16641 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16642 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16643 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16644 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16645 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16648 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016649 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16650 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16651 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16652 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654 ACL alternatives :
16655 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16658 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16659 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16660 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16661 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016663 ACL alternatives :
16664 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016666 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668req.proto_http : boolean
16669req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16670 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16671 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16672 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16673 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16674 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16675 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16676 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016678 Example:
16679 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16680 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16681 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016682 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16685rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16686 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16687 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16688 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16689 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16690 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16691 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16692 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16695 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16696 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16697 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16698 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16699 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701 ACL derivatives :
16702 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704 Example :
16705 listen tse-farm
16706 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16707 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16708 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16709 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16710 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16711 persist rdp-cookie
16712 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16713 # This is only useful makes sense if
16714 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16715 stick-table type string size 204800
16716 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16717 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16718 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16721 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016723req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16724rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16725 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16726 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16727 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16728 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730 ACL derivatives :
16731 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016732
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016733req.ssl_alpn : string
16734 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16735 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16736 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16737 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16738 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16739 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016740 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016741
16742 Examples :
16743 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16744 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16745 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016746 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016747 default_backend bk_default
16748
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016749req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16750 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16751 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016752 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16753 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16754 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16755 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16756 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16759req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16760 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16761 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16762 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16763 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16764 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16765 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16766 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768req.ssl_sni : string
16769req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16770 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16771 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16772 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16773 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16774 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16775 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16776 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16777 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16778 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16779 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16780 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16781 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783 ACL derivatives :
16784 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 Examples :
16787 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16788 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16789 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16790 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16791 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016792
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016793req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16794 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16795 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16796 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16797 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16798 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16799 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16800 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16801 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16802 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804req.ssl_ver : integer
16805req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16806 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16807 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16808 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16809 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16810 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16811 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16812 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016813 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 ACL derivatives :
16817 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016818
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016819res.len : integer
16820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16821 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16822 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16823 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16824 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16825 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16826 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16827 content inspection.
16828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16830 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016831 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16832 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16833 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16834 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16837 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16838 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16839 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16840 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016843
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016844res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16845rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16846 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16847 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16848 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16849 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16850 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16851 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16852 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854wait_end : boolean
16855 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16856 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016858 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16859 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016860 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016861 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16862 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 Examples :
16865 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16866 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16867 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16870 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16871 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16872 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16873 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16874 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16875 tcp-request content reject
16876
16877
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168787.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879--------------------------------------
16880
16881It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16882This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16883data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16884its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16885HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16886content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16887to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16888more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16889response are indexed.
16890
16891base : string
16892 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16893 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16894 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16895 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16896 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16897 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16898 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16899 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16900
16901 ACL derivatives :
16902 base : exact string match
16903 base_beg : prefix match
16904 base_dir : subdir match
16905 base_dom : domain match
16906 base_end : suffix match
16907 base_len : length match
16908 base_reg : regex match
16909 base_sub : substring match
16910
16911base32 : integer
16912 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16913 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16914 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016915 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16916 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16917 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016918
16919base32+src : binary
16920 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16921 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16922 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16923 per-URL counters.
16924
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016925capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16926 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16927 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16928 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16929
16930capture.req.method : string
16931 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16932 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16933 because it's allocated.
16934
16935capture.req.uri : string
16936 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16937 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16938 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16939 allocated.
16940
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016941capture.req.ver : string
16942 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16943 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16944 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16945
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016946capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16947 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16948 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16949 The first entry is an index of 0.
16950 See also: "capture response header"
16951
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016952capture.res.ver : string
16953 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16954 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16955 persistent flag.
16956
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016957req.body : binary
16958 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16959 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16960 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16961 the first chunk is analyzed.
16962
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016963req.body_param([<name>) : string
16964 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16965 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16966 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16967 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16968 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16969 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16970 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16971 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16972 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16973 given.
16974
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016975req.body_len : integer
16976 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16977 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16978 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16979 "option http-buffer-request".
16980
16981req.body_size : integer
16982 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16983 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16984 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16985 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16986 "option http-buffer-request".
16987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988req.cook([<name>]) : string
16989cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16990 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16991 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16992 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16993 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16994 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16995 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16996 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16997 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16998
16999 ACL derivatives :
17000 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17001 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17002 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17003 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17004 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17005 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17006 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17007 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017009req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17010cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17011 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17012 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017014req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17015cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17016 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17017 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17018 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17019 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017021cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17022 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17023 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17024 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17025 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017026 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017027 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17028 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17029 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17030 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017032hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17033 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17034 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17035 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17036 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017037 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017039req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17040 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17041 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17042 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17043 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17044 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17045 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17046 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17047 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017049req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17050 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17051 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17052 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17053 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17056 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17057 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17058 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17059 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17060 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17061 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17062 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17063 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017064 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017066 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068 ACL derivatives :
17069 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17070 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17071 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17072 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17073 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17074 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17075 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17076 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17077
17078req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17079hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17080 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17081 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17082 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17083 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17084 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17085 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17086 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17087 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17088 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17089
17090req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17091hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17092 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17093 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17094 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17095 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17096 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017097 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17099 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17100
17101req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17102hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17103 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17104 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17105 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17106 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17107 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17108 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17109 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17110
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017111
17112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017113http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17114 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17115 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17116 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17117 basic auth is supported.
17118
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017119http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17120 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17121 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17122 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17123 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17125 basic auth is supported.
17126
17127 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017128 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17129 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17130 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17131 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017133http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017134 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17135 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17136 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017137
17138http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017139 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17140 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17141 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017142
17143http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017144 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17145 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17146 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017148http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017149 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17150 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017151 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17152 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017154method : integer + string
17155 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17156 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17157 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17158 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17159 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17160 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17161 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163 ACL derivatives :
17164 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166 Example :
17167 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17168 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17169 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171path : string
17172 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17173 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17174 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17175 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17176 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017177 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180 ACL derivatives :
17181 path : exact string match
17182 path_beg : prefix match
17183 path_dir : subdir match
17184 path_dom : domain match
17185 path_end : suffix match
17186 path_len : length match
17187 path_reg : regex match
17188 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017189
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017190query : string
17191 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17192 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17193 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17194 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017195 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017196 which stops before the question mark.
17197
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017198req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17199 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17200 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17201 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17202 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017204req.ver : string
17205req_ver : string (deprecated)
17206 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17207 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17208 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017210 ACL derivatives :
17211 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213res.comp : boolean
17214 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17215 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17216 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218res.comp_algo : string
17219 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17220 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17221 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223res.cook([<name>]) : string
17224scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17225 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17226 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17227 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229 ACL derivatives :
17230 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017232res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17233scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17234 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17235 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17236 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17239scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17240 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17241 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17242 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17246 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17247 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17248 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17249 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17250 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17251 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17252 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17253 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17256 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17257 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17258 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17259 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17260 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017262res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17263shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17264 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17265 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17266 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17267 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17268 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17269 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17270 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17271 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273 ACL derivatives :
17274 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17275 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17276 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17277 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17278 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17279 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17280 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17281 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17282
17283res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17284shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17285 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17286 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17287 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17288 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17289 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017291res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17292shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17293 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17294 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17295 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17296 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17297 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17298 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017299
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017300res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17301 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17302 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17303 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17304 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17307shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17308 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17309 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17310 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17311 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17312 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17313 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315res.ver : string
17316resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17317 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17318 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320 ACL derivatives :
17321 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17324 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17325 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017326 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17330 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332status : integer
17333 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17334 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17335 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017336
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017337unique-id : string
17338 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17339 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17340 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17341 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17342 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17343 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345url : string
17346 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17347 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17348 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17349 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17350 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17351 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17352 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354 ACL derivatives :
17355 url : exact string match
17356 url_beg : prefix match
17357 url_dir : subdir match
17358 url_dom : domain match
17359 url_end : suffix match
17360 url_len : length match
17361 url_reg : regex match
17362 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364url_ip : ip
17365 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17366 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17367 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17368 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17369 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17370 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17371 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373url_port : integer
17374 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17375 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17376 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17377 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017378
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017379urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17380url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17382 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017383 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17384 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17385 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17386 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017387 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17388 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017389 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17390 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392 ACL derivatives :
17393 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17394 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17395 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17396 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17397 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17398 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17399 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17400 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017401
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403 Example :
17404 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17405 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17406 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17407 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017408
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017409urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017410 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17411 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17412 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017413
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017414url32 : integer
17415 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17416 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17417 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17418 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17419 is an unsigned integer.
17420
17421url32+src : binary
17422 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17423 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17424 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17425
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017426
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200174277.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17428-------------------------------------
17429
17430This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17431context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17432placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17433when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17434adapted to be called in this context.
17435
17436check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17437 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17438 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17439 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17440 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17441 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17442 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17443
17444
174457.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017446---------------------------------------
17447
17448This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17449used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17450purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17451There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17452or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17453any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17454for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17455
17456internal.htx.data : integer
17457 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17458 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17459
17460internal.htx.free : integer
17461 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17462 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17463
17464internal.htx.free_data : integer
17465 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17466 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17467
17468internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17469 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17470 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17471 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17472
17473internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17474 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17475 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17476
17477internal.htx.size : integer
17478 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17479 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17480
17481internal.htx.used : integer
17482 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17483 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17484 direction.
17485
17486internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17487 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17488 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17489 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17490 of the special value :
17491 * head : The oldest inserted block
17492 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017493 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017494
17495internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17496 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17497 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17498 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17499 integer or one of the special value :
17500 * head : The oldest inserted block
17501 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017502 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017503
17504internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17505 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17506 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17507 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17508 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17509
17510 * head : The oldest inserted block
17511 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017512 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017513
17514internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17515 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17516 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17517 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17518 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17519
17520 * head : The oldest inserted block
17521 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017522 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017523
17524internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17525 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17526 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17527 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17528 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17529
17530 * head : The oldest inserted block
17531 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017532 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017533
17534internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17535 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17536 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17537 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17538 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17539
17540 * head : The oldest inserted block
17541 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017542 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017543
17544internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17545 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17546 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17547 it returns false.
17548
17549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175507.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017551---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017553Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17554every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017555order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017557ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17558---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017559FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017560HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017561HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17562HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017563HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17564HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17565HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17566HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17567LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017568METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017569METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017570METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17571METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17572METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17573METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017574METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017575METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017576RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017577REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017578TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017579WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17580---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017581
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175838. Logging
17584----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017585
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17587provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17588very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17589provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17590state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017591to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017592headers.
17593
17594In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17595about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17596send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17597
17598 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17599 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17600 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17601 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17602 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017603 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017604 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605
17606The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17607allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17608as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17609while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17610real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17611delay.
17612
17613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176148.1. Log levels
17615---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017616
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017617TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017618source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017619HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17620in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17621track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17622syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17623about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624
17625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176268.2. Log formats
17627----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017628
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017629HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017630and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17631slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17632options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017633
17634 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17635 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17636 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17637 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17638 extents.
17639
17640 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17641 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17642 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17643 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17644 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17645
17646 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17647 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17648 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17649 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17650 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17651
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017652 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17653 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17654 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17655 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17656
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017657 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17658
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17660specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17661field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17662servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17663always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17664identifier.
17665
17666Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17667 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17668 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17669 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17670 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17671
17672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176738.2.1. Default log format
17674-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017675
17676This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17677as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17678format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17679
17680 Example :
17681 listen www
17682 mode http
17683 log global
17684 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17685
17686 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17687 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17688 (www/HTTP)
17689
17690 Field Format Extract from the example above
17691 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17692 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17693 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17694 4 'to' to
17695 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17696 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17697
17698Detailed fields description :
17699 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17700 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17701 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17702 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17703 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17704 and processed the connection.
17705 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17706
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017707In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17708"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17709connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17712will eventually disappear.
17713
17714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177158.2.2. TCP log format
17716---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17719is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17720information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17721counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17722emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17723environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17724the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17725sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017726specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17727not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17728fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17729marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730
17731 Example :
17732 frontend fnt
17733 mode tcp
17734 option tcplog
17735 log global
17736 default_backend bck
17737
17738 backend bck
17739 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17740
17741 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17742 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17743 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17744
17745 Field Format Extract from the example above
17746 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17747 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17748 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17749 4 frontend_name fnt
17750 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17751 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17752 7 bytes_read* 212
17753 8 termination_state --
17754 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17755 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17756
17757Detailed fields description :
17758 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017759 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17760 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17761 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017762 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017763 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017764 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017767 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17768 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17769 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017770
17771 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17772 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17773 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017774 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17775 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17776 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17777 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017778
17779 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17780 and processed the connection.
17781
17782 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17783 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17784 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17785 applications.
17786
17787 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17788 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17789 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17790 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17791 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17792
17793 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17794 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17795 See "Timers" below for more details.
17796
17797 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17798 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17799 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17800 "Timers" below for more details.
17801
17802 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017803 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017804 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17805 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17806 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17807 details.
17808
17809 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17810 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17811 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17812 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17813 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17814
17815 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17816 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17817 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17818 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17819 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17820 for more details.
17821
17822 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017823 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17825 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17826 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017827 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828
17829 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17830 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17831 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17832 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17833 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17834 caused by a denial of service attack.
17835
17836 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17837 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17838 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17839 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17840 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17841 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17842 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17843 denial of service attack.
17844
17845 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17846 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17847 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17848 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17849 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17850 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17851 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17852 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17853 be processed than on other servers.
17854
17855 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17856 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17857 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17858 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17859 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17860 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17861 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17862 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17863 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17864 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17865 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17866 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17867 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17868
17869 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17870 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17871 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17872 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17873 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17874 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017875 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17877
17878 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17879 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17880 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17881 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17882 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17883 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017885 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17886 occurs.
17887
17888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178898.2.3. HTTP log format
17890----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017891
17892The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17893is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17894the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17895are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17896emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17897generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17898"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17899which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017900frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17901is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017902
17903Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17904slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17905with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17906
17907 Example :
17908 frontend http-in
17909 mode http
17910 option httplog
17911 log global
17912 default_backend bck
17913
17914 backend static
17915 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17916
17917 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17918 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17919 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017920 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017921
17922 Field Format Extract from the example above
17923 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17924 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017925 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 4 frontend_name http-in
17927 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017928 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017929 7 status_code 200
17930 8 bytes_read* 2750
17931 9 captured_request_cookie -
17932 10 captured_response_cookie -
17933 11 termination_state ----
17934 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17935 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17936 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17937 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17938 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940Detailed fields description :
17941 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017942 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17943 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17944 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017945 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017946 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017947 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017948
17949 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017950 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17951 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17952 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017954 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17955 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956
17957 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17958 and processed the connection.
17959
17960 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17961 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17962 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17963
17964 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17965 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17966 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17967 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17968 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17969 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17970
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017971 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17972 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17973 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017974 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017975 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17976 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017977 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17978 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979
17980 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17981 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017982 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017983
17984 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17985 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017986 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17987 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017988
17989 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17990 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17991 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17992 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17993 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017994 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17995 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017997 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17998 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17999 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18000 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18001 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18002 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18003 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018004 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018005
18006 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18007 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18008 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18009
18010 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18011 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018012 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018013 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18014 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18015 overflowing.
18016
18017 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18018 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18019 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18020 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18021 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18022 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18023 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18024 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18025
18026 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18027 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18028 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18029 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18030 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18031 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18032 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18033 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18034
18035 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18036 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18037 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18038 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18039 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18040 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18041 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18042
18043 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018044 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018045 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18046 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18047 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018048 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018049 system.
18050
18051 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18052 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18053 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18054 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18055 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18056 caused by a denial of service attack.
18057
18058 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18059 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18060 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18061 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18062 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18063 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18064 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18065 denial of service attack.
18066
18067 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18068 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18069 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18070 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18071 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18072 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18073 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18074 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18075 processed than on other servers.
18076
18077 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18078 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18079 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18080 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18081 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18082 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18083 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18084 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18085 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18086 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18087 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18088 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18089 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18090
18091 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18092 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18093 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18094 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18095 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18096 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018097 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018098 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18099
18100 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18101 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18102 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18103 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18104 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18105 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018106 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018107 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18108 occurs.
18109
18110 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18111 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18112 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18113 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18114 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18115 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18116 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18117 cookies" below for more details.
18118
18119 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18120 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18121 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18122 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18123 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18124 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18125 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18126 and cookies" below for more details.
18127
18128 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18129 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18130 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18131 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18132 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18133 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18134 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18135 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18136
18137
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200181388.2.4. Custom log format
18139------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018140
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018141The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018142mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018143
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018144HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018145Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18146separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18147prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18148
18149Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18150variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018151("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018152
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018153If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018154as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018155less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18156the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018158Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018159In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018160in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018161
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018162Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18163'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18164https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18165such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018167Flags are :
18168 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018169 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018170 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18171 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018172
18173 Example:
18174
18175 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18176 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18177
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018178 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18179
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018180At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18181
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018182 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18183 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018184
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018185the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018186
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018187 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18188 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18189 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018190
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018191and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18192
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018193 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18194 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018195
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018196Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18197
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018198 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018199 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018200 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18201 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18202 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018203 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18204 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18205 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018206 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018207 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18208 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018209 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018210 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18211 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018212 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018213 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018214 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018215 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018216 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018217 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018218 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018219 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18220 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18221 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18222 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18223 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018224 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018225 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
18226 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018227 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018228 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18229 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018230 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18231 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18232 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018233 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018234 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18235 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018236 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018237 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18238 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18239 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018240 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018241 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018242 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18243 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18244 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18245 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018246 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018247 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018248 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018249 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018250 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018251 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018252 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18253 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18254 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018255 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018256 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18257 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018258 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018259 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18260 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018261 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018262 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018263 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018264 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018265
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018266 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018267
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018268
182698.2.5. Error log format
18270-----------------------
18271
18272When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18273protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18274By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18275"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018276will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018277logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18278
18279The format looks like this :
18280
18281 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18282 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18283 Connection error during SSL handshake
18284
18285 Field Format Extract from the example above
18286 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18287 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18288 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18289 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18290 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18291
18292These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18293failures.
18294
18295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182968.3. Advanced logging options
18297-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018298
18299Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18300just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18301options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18302for more information about their usage.
18303
18304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18306------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018307
18308It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18309haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18310commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18311monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18312ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18313
18314 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18315 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18316 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18317 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18318
18319 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18320 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18321 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018322 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018323 such as other load-balancers.
18324
18325 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18326 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18327 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18328
18329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18331----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018332
18333The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18334what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18335or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018336"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018337just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18338log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18339after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18340is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18341with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18342with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18343
18344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18346------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018347
18348Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18349for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18350"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18351retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18352raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18353a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18354file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18355you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18356"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18357
18358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18360--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018361
18362Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18363multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18364them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18365"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18366logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18367error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18368and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18369too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18370useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18371alternative.
18372
18373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183748.4. Timing events
18375------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018376
18377Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18378reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18379the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18380frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018381mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18382addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18383
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018384Timings events in HTTP mode:
18385
18386 first request 2nd request
18387 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18388 t tr t tr ...
18389 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18390 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18391 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18392 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18393 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18394
18395Timings events in TCP mode:
18396
18397 TCP session
18398 |<----------------->|
18399 t t
18400 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18401 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18402 |<------ Tt ------->|
18403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018404 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018405 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018406 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18407 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18408 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018409 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018410 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18411 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18412 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18413 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018414
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018415 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18416 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18417 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018418 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18419 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18420 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18421 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18422 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18423 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018424
18425 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18426 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18427 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18428 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18429 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18430 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18431 request typed by hand during a test.
18432
18433 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18434 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018435 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018436 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18437 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18438 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18439 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018440
18441 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18442 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18443 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18444 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18445 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18446
18447 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18448 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18449 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18450 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18451 connection never established.
18452
18453 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18454 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18455 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18456 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18457 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18458 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18459 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18460 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18461 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18462 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18463 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18464
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018465 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18466 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18467 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18468 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18469 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18470 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18471
18472 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18473
18474 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18475 "Ta" can never be negative.
18476
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018477 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18478 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018479 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18480 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018481 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018482
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018483 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018484
18485 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018486 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18487 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018488
18489These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18490protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18491that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018492due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18493"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18494that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018495
18496Most common cases :
18497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018498 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18499 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18500 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18501 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18502 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18503 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18504 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18505 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18506 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18507 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18508 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018509 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018510
18511 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18512 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18513 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18514 of ms on remote networks.
18515
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018516 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18517 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18518 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018519
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018520 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18521 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18522 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18523 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18524 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18525 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18526 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18527 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18528 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018529
18530Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018532 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018533 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018534 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018535
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018536 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018537 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18538 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18539
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018540 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018541 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18542 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18543 flags.
18544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018545 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18546 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018547 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18548 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18549 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18550 the client connection was maintained open.
18551
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018552 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018553 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018554 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018555 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18556
18557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185588.5. Session state at disconnection
18559-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018560
18561TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18562"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
185632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18564each of which has a special meaning :
18565
18566 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18567 session to terminate :
18568
18569 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18570
18571 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18572 server explicitly refused it.
18573
18574 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18575 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18576 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18577 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018578 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018579
18580 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18581 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018582
18583 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18584 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18585 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18586 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18587 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18588
18589 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18590 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18591 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18592 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18593 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18594
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018595 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18596 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18597
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018598 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18599 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18600 backup connections when going up.
18601
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018602 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018604 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18605 send or receive data.
18606
18607 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18608 send or receive data.
18609
18610 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18611 with nothing left in the buffers.
18612
18613 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18614
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018615 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018616 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18617
18618 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18619 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18620 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18621 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18622 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18623
18624 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18625 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18626
18627 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18628 server (HTTP only).
18629
18630 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18631
18632 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18633 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18634 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18635
18636 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18637 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18638 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18639
18640 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18641
18642 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18643 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18644
18645 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18646 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18647 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18648
18649 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18650 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018651 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18652 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018653
18654 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18655 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18656 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18657 another server.
18658
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018659 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018660 server.
18661
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018662 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18663 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18664 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18665 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18666
18667 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18668 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18669 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18670 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18671
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018672 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18673 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18674 "use-server" rule).
18675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018676 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18677
18678 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18679 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18680
18681 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18682
18683 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18684 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18685 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18686
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018687 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18688 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018689 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018690 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18691 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018693 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18694
18695 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18696 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18697
18698 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18699
18700 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18701
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018702The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18703was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018704helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18705starvation, attacks, etc...
18706
18707The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18708alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18709easier finding and understanding.
18710
18711 Flags Reason
18712
18713 -- Normal termination.
18714
18715 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18716 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18717 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18718 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18719
18720 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18721 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18722 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18723 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18724 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18725 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018726
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018727 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18728 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018729 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018730
18731 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18732 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18733 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18734
18735 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18736 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18737 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18738 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18739 the server takes too long to respond.
18740
18741 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18742 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18743 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18744 long a time to respond.
18745
18746 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18747 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18748 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18749 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018750 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18751 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018752
18753 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18754 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18755 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18756 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18757 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018758 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018759 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18760 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18761 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18762 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18763 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18764 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18765 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18766 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018767 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018768 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18769 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18770 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018771
18772 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18773 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018774 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18775 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18776 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18777 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018778
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018779 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18780 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018782 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018783 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18784 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018785 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018786 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18787 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18788
18789 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18790 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18791 503 or 504 here.
18792
18793 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18794 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18795 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18796 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18797 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18798
18799 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18800 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018801 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018802 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18803 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18804
18805 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18806 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18807 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18808 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18809 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18810 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18811 between haproxy and the server.
18812
18813 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18814 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18815 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18816 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18817 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18818 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18819 solution is to fix the application.
18820
18821 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18822 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18823 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18824 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18825 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18826 external attacks.
18827
18828 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18829 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018830 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018831 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18832 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18833
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018834 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18835 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18836 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018837 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018838 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018839
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018840 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18841 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18842 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18843 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018844 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18845 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18846 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18847 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18848 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018849
18850 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18851 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18852 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18853 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18854
18855 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18856 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18857 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18858 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18859
18860 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18861 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18862 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18863 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18864
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018865The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18866persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18867important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18868re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18869
18870 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18871
18872 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18873 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18874 set on a GET request.
18875
18876 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18877 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018878 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018879 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18880
18881 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18882 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18883 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18884
18885 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18886 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18887 already got a cookie.
18888
18889 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18890 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18891 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18892 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18893 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18894
18895 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18896 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18897 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18898
18899 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18900 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18901 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18902
18903 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18904 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18905
18906 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18907 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18908 then advertised in the response.
18909
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189118.6. Non-printable characters
18912-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018913
18914In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18915consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18916converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18917prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18918being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18919escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18920is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18921'}' when logging headers.
18922
18923Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18924issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18925containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18926
18927Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18928the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18929performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18930
18931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189328.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18933---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018934
18935Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18936achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018937section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018938cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18939the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18940the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018941locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018942not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18943user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18944a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18945wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18946
18947 Examples :
18948 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18949 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18950
18951 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18952 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18953
18954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189558.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18956---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018957
18958Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18959proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18960the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18961server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18962
18963Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18964response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018965section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018966
18967It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018968time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18969appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018970are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18971and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18972follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18973request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18974in the logs.
18975
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018976As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18977frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18978an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018980 Example :
18981 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18982 listen proxy-out
18983 mode http
18984 option httplog
18985 option logasap
18986 log global
18987 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18988
18989 # log the name of the virtual server
18990 capture request header Host len 20
18991
18992 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18993 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18994
18995 # log the beginning of the referrer
18996 capture request header Referer len 20
18997
18998 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18999 capture response header Server len 20
19000
19001 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19002 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19003
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019004 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019005 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19006
19007 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19008 capture response header Via len 20
19009
19010 # log the URL location during a redirection
19011 capture response header Location len 20
19012
19013 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19014 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19015 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19016 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19017 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19018
19019 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19020 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19021 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19022 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019023 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019024
19025 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19026 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19027 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19028 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19029 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019030 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031
19032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190338.9. Examples of logs
19034---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019035
19036These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19037them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19038reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19039
19040 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19041 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19042 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19043
19044 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19045 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19046
19047 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19048 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19049 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19050
19051 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19052 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19053
19054 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19055 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19056 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19057
19058 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019059 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019060 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19061 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19062
19063 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19064 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19065 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19066
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019067 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19068 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19069 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19070 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19071 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19072 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019073
19074 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019075 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019076
19077 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19078 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19079 Nothing was sent to any server.
19080
19081 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19082 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19083
19084 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19085 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019086 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087 send a 408 return code to the client.
19088
19089 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19090 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19091
19092 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19093 5 seconds ("c----").
19094
19095 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19096 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019097 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019098
19099 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019100 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019101 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19102 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19103 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19104 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19105 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019106
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019107
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200191089. Supported filters
19109--------------------
19110
19111Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19112accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19113unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19114
19115See also : "filter"
19116
191179.1. Trace
19118----------
19119
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019120filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019121
19122 Arguments:
19123 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19124 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19125
19126 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19127 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19128 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19129 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019131 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019132 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19133 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19134 amount of the parsed data.
19135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019136 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019137
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019138This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19139callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19140information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19141filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19142
19143Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19144tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19145a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19146
19147
191489.2. HTTP compression
19149---------------------
19150
19151filter compression
19152
19153The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19154keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019155when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19156fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19157done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19158explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19159filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19160listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19161order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019162
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019163See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19164 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019165
19166
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200191679.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19168--------------------------------------------
19169
19170filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19171
19172 Arguments :
19173
19174 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19175 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19176 parsed.
19177
19178 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19179 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19180 part must be placed in its own scope.
19181
19182The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19183external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019184streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019185exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19186also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19187
19188SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19189the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19190
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019191For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019192"doc/SPOE.txt".
19193
19194Important note:
19195 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
19196 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
19197
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100191989.4. Cache
19199----------
19200
19201filter cache <name>
19202
19203 Arguments :
19204
19205 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19206
19207The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19208"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019209cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019210other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19211case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19212is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19213filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019214listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19215order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019216
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019217See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19218 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19219
19220
192219.5. Fcgi-app
19222-------------
19223
19224filter fcg-app <name>
19225
19226 Arguments :
19227
19228 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19229
19230The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19231request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19232reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19233used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19234implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19235used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19236fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19237used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19238order.
19239
19240See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19241 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19242
19243
1924410. FastCGI applications
19245-------------------------
19246
19247HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19248feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19249the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19250FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19251servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19252FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19253backend.
19254
19255HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19256application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19257connection.
19258
1925910.1. Setup
19260-----------
19261
1926210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19263--------------------------
19264
19265fcgi-app <name>
19266 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19267 document root must be defined.
19268
19269acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19270 Declare or complete an access list.
19271
19272 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19273 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19274 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19275 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19276 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19277
19278docroot <path>
19279 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19280 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19281 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19282
19283index <script-name>
19284 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19285 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19286 is an optional setting.
19287
19288 Example :
19289 index index.php
19290
19291log-stderr global
19292log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19293 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19294 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19295
19296 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19297 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19298
19299pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19300 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19301 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19302 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19303
19304 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19305 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19306 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19307 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19308
19309 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19310 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19311
19312path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019313 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019314 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19315 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19316 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19317 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19318 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19319 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19320 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019321
19322 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019323 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019324 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19325 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19326 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19327 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019328
19329 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019330 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19331 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019332
19333option get-values
19334no option get-values
19335 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19336
19337 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19338 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19339
19340 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19341 application will accept.
19342
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019343 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19344 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019345
19346 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19347 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19348 option is disabled.
19349
19350 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19351 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19352 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19353 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19354 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19355 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19356
19357option keep-conn
19358no option keep-conn
19359 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19360 sending a response.
19361
19362 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19363 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19364
19365option max-reqs <reqs>
19366 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19367 accept.
19368
19369 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19370 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19371 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19372 to 1.
19373
19374option mpxs-conns
19375no option mpxs-conns
19376 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19377
19378 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19379 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19380
19381set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19382 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19383 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19384 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19385 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19386
19387 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19388 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19389 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19390
19391 Example :
19392 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19393 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19394
19395 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19396
19397
1939810.1.2. Proxy section
19399---------------------
19400
19401use-fcgi-app <name>
19402 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19403
19404 Arguments :
19405 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19406
19407 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19408 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19409 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19410 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19411 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19412
19413 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19414 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19415 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19416 application are evaluated.
19417
19418
1941910.1.3. Example
19420---------------
19421
19422 frontend front-http
19423 mode http
19424 bind *:80
19425 bind *:
19426
19427 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19428 default_backend back-static
19429
19430 backend back-static
19431 mode http
19432 server www A.B.C.D:80
19433
19434 backend back-dynamic
19435 mode http
19436 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19437 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19438
19439 fcgi-app php-fpm
19440 log-stderr global
19441 option keep-conn
19442
19443 docroot /var/www/my-app
19444 index index.php
19445 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19446
19447
1944810.2. Default parameters
19449------------------------
19450
19451A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19452the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019453script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019454applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19455
19456 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19457 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19458 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19459 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19460 | | |
19461 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19462 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19463 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19464 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19465 | | application. |
19466 | | |
19467 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19468 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19469 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19470 | | |
19471 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19472 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19473 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19474 | | the application's configuration. |
19475 | | |
19476 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19477 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19478 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19479 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19480 | | |
19481 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19482 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19483 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19484 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19485 | | be defined. |
19486 | | |
19487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19488 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19489 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19490 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19491 | | is not set too. |
19492 | | |
19493 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19494 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19495 | | set. |
19496 | | |
19497 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19498 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19499 | | the request. |
19500 | | |
19501 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19502 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19503 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19504 | | |
19505 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19506 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19507 | | script to process the request. |
19508 | | |
19509 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19510 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19511 | | |
19512 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19513 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19514 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19515 | | |
19516 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19517 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19518 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19519 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19520 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19521 | | |
19522 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19523 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19524 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19525 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19526 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19527 | | side. |
19528 | | |
19529 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19530 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19531 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19532 | | connected to. |
19533 | | |
19534 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19535 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19536 | | |
19537 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19538 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19539 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19540 | | |
19541 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19542
19543
1954410.3. Limitations
19545------------------
19546
19547The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19548way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19549during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19550establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19551application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19552or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19553message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19554these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19555and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19556
19557Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19558request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19559requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19560
19561About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19562into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19563fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19564"http-request" ones.
19565
19566Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19567FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19568processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19569must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19570here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019572/*
19573 * Local variables:
19574 * fill-column: 79
19575 * End:
19576 */